Lexmark Printer M412 User Manual

M410  
M412  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Edition: May 2000  
The following paragraph does not apply to any country where such provisions are inconsistent with local law: LEXMARK INTERNATIONAL, INC.,  
PROVIDES THIS PUBLICATION “AS IS” WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. Some states do not allow  
disclaimer of express or implied warranties in certain transactions; therefore, this statement may not apply to you.  
This publication could include technical inaccuracies or typographical errors. Changes are periodically made to the information herein; these changes  
will be incorporated in later editions. Improvements or changes in the products or the programs described may be made at any time.  
A form for the readers comments is provided at the back of this publication. If the form has been removed, comments may be addressed to Lexmark  
International, Inc., Department F95/ 035-3, 740 West New Circle Road, Lexington, Kentucky 40550, U.S.A. In the United Kingdom and Eire, send to  
Lexmark International Ltd., Marketing and Services Department, Westhorpe House, Westhorpe, Marlow Bucks SL7 3RQ. Lexmark may use or distribute  
any of the information you supply in any way it believes appropriate without incurring any obligation to you. You can purchase additional copies of  
publications related to this product by calling 1-800-553-9727. In the United Kingdom and Eire, call 0628-481500. In other countries, contact your point of  
purchase.  
References in this publication to products, programs, or services do not imply that the manufacturer intends to make these available in all countries in  
which it operates. Any reference to a product, program, or service is not intended to state or imply that only that product, program, or service may be  
used. Any functionally equivalent product, program, or service that does not infringe any existing intellectual property right may be used instead.  
Evaluation and verification of operation in conjunction with other products, programs, or services, except those expressly designated by the  
manufacturer, are the users responsibility.  
© Copyright 1999, 2000 Lexmark International, Inc.  
All rights reserved.  
UNITED STATES GOVERNMENT RESTRICTED RIGHTS  
This software and documentation are provided with RESTRICTED RIGHTS. Use, duplication or disclosure by the Government is subject to restrictions  
as set forth in subparagraph (c)(1)(ii) of the Rights in Technical Data and Computer Software clause at DFARS 252.227-7013 and in applicable FAR  
provisions: Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY 40550.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of  
Contents  
Table of Contents  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Table of Contents  
vii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
About This Book This Users Guide contains information about the Lexmark  
Optra M410 and M412 laser printers. It provides setup  
instructions for the printer and printer options as well as  
information about loading print material, changing  
printer settings, replacing printer supplies, and trouble-  
shooting problems.  
Keep this book in a handy place and use it as a reference  
when you have a question about printer function or if you  
encounter a printing problem.  
It may be helpful for you to recognize the following con-  
ventions used throughout this book:  
Notes, warnings, and cautions appear in the left col-  
umn for easy reference.  
Note: A note provides informa-  
tion you may find useful.  
Operator panel buttons are printed in boldface type:  
Warning! A warning identifies  
something that could damage  
your printer hardware or soft-  
ware.  
Press Go after changing a menu setting.  
Messages, menu names, menu items, and menu set-  
tings that appear on the operator panel display are  
also printed in boldface type:  
Caution! A caution identifies  
something that could cause you  
harm.  
If Load Tray 1 appears on the operator panel dis-  
play, you must load print material in tray 1 and  
press Go before you can resume printing.  
Introduction  
ix  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
The Paper Source setting is available in the PAPER  
MENU.  
Other Information In addition to this Users Guide, Lexmark offers the follow-  
ing sources of information about your printer and other  
Lexmark products and services.  
Online Documents  
The Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities compact disc (CD)  
that comes with your printer contains several online docu-  
ments. Refer to the booklet that comes with the CD for  
launching instructions. Once you launch the CD, click  
View Documentation to display a list of available docu-  
ments.  
The CD includes:  
The MarkVision printer utility information, which pro-  
vides step-by-step instructions for installing MarkVision  
for Windows 95/ 98/ 2000, Windows NT 4.0, Macintosh,  
and OS/ 2 on several different networks. It also describes  
some of the most popular MarkVision features.  
Documents which provide general information  
about setting up an optional print server after  
installing it in your printer.  
Documents which describe font options and avail-  
able resources.  
A Card Stock & Label Guide which provides detailed  
information about selecting print material appropri-  
ate for your printer.  
A Technical Reference which includes information  
about printer languages and commands, interface  
specification, and printer memory management.  
Introduction  
x
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Trademarks  
Lexmark, Lexmark with diamond design, MarkNet,  
MarkVision, and Optra are trademarks of Lexmark Inter-  
national, Inc., registered in the United States and/ or other  
countries.  
MarkTrack, Optra Forms, and PictureGrade are trade-  
marks of Lexmark International, Inc.  
Operation ReSource is a service mark of Lexmark Interna-  
tional, Inc.  
PCL® is a registered trademark of the Hewlett-Packard  
Company. PCL 6 is Hewlett-Packard Companys designa-  
tions of a set of printer commands (language) and func-  
tions included in its printer products. This printer is  
intended to be compatible with the PCL 6 language. This  
means the printer recognizes PCL 6 commands used in  
various application programs, and that the printer emu-  
lates the functions corresponding to the commands.  
PostScript® is a registered trademark of Adobe Systems  
Incorporated. PostScript 3 is Adobe Systemsdesignation  
of a set of printer commands (language), fonts, and func-  
tions included in its software products. This printer is  
intended to be compatible with the PostScript 3 language.  
This means the printer recognizes PostScript 3 commands  
used in various application programs, and that the printer  
emulates the functions corresponding to the commands.  
Details relating to compatibility are included in the  
Technical Reference.  
Trademarks  
xi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
The following terms are trademarks or registered trade-  
marks of these companies.  
Albertus  
The Monotype Corporation plc.  
Monsieur Marcel OLIVE  
Antique Olive  
Arial  
The Monotype Corporation plc.  
A product of Bayer Corporation  
CG Omega  
CG Times  
Based on Times New Roman under  
license from The Monotype  
Corporation plc, is a product of  
Bayer Corporation  
Helvetica  
Linotype-Hell AG and/ or its  
subsidiaries  
Intellifont  
Bayer Corporation  
ITC Bookman  
International Typeface Corporation  
ITC Zapf Chancery International Typeface Corporation  
LocalTalk  
Macintosh  
Marigold  
Palatino  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
AlphaOmega Typography, Inc.  
Linotype-Hell AG and/ or its  
subsidiaries  
Pantone  
Pantone, Inc.  
PostScript  
Adobe Systems Incorporated  
Times New Roman The Monotype Corporation plc.  
TrueType  
Univers  
Apple Computer, Inc.  
Linotype-Hell AG and/ or its  
subsidiaries  
Wingdings  
Microsoft Corporation  
Other trademarks are the property of their respective  
owners.  
Trademarks  
xii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Up  
Your Printer  
1
Complete the following sections to set up your Lexmark™  
OptraM410 and M412 printers.  
Unpacking  
Your Printer  
1 Remove the printer and all items from the packag-  
ing carton.  
Save the carton and packing materials in case you  
need to repack the printer for service or storage.  
Plastic Bracket  
2 Make sure you have the items shown.  
Printer  
If any items are missing, contact the place where  
you bought your printer.  
3 Place the printer on a flat, sturdy surface in a well-  
ventilated area.  
Allow at least 304.8 mm (12 in.) of clearance on all  
sides of the printer. Since you may want to install  
the optional 500-sheet drawer, leave at least  
129.6 mm (5.1 in.) clearance above the printer. Leave  
enough space in front of the printer to allow for  
easy paper access.  
Power  
Cord  
Metal  
Bail  
User’s  
Guide  
CD  
Unpacking Your Printer  
1
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Use the following information to help determine  
where to place your printer.  
Characteristic  
Measurement  
435 mm (17.1 in.)  
314 mm (12.4 in.)  
405 mm (15.9 in.)  
14.8 kg (32.6 lb)  
246 sq. in.  
Depth  
Height  
Width  
Weight  
1
Footprint  
1
Weight of printer includes print cartridge.  
Do not place the printer:  
In direct sunlight.  
Near heat sources or air conditioners.  
In dusty or dirty environments.  
Removing Print To remove the print cartridge packaging:  
Cartridge  
Packaging  
1 Push the upper release latch to release the upper  
Upper  
Front Door  
front door.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
2
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
2 Raise the upper front door.  
It remains in place.  
3 Grasp the print cartridge by the handgrip.  
Removing Print Cartridge Packaging  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 Lift the print cartridge up and pull out.  
5 Pull up on each end of the plastic piece and then  
remove the packaging material.  
Discard all packaging material: the plastic piece, the  
foam, and the paper connected to the foam.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Installing the To prepare the print cartridge for printing:  
Print Cartridge  
1 Gently shake the print cartridge side-to-side to  
distribute the toner.  
2 Insert the print cartridge:  
Tab  
Slot  
a Align the tabs located on each side of the print  
cartridge with the slots on either side of the  
print cartridge cradle as shown.  
Use the colored arrows inside the printer for  
placement.  
Installing the Print Cartridge  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
b Slide the print cartridge straight back into the  
printer until it snaps into place.  
3 Close the upper front door.  
You cannot close the door completely if the print  
cartridge is not installed correctly.  
Loading the Your printer has one standard 250-sheet input tray that  
holds five paper sizes. For information on the different  
sizes and types of print material you can use with your  
Standard  
Input Tray  
For information on loading envelopes and other types of  
To load paper:  
1 Pull the input tray straight out of the printer.  
Remove the input tray completely from the printer.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
2 Press down on the metal plate until it locks into  
place.  
The metal plate remains stationary on the inside  
bottom of the input tray.  
3 Press down on the length guide tab with one  
hand, and with the other hand slide the length  
guide to the correct position for the size paper you  
are loading.  
Paper Size  
Indicators  
Length Guide  
Length  
Guide  
Tab  
Use the paper size indicators to adjust the length  
guide for one of the following five paper sizes: A4,  
B5, LTR (Letter), LGL (Legal), and EXEC (Execu-  
tive).  
Paper Size  
Indicators  
Note: The paper size indica-  
tors are paper size abbreviations  
used for the placement of the  
length guide as shown. This  
example shows how to adjust for  
letter-size paper (LTR).  
Loading the Standard Input Tray  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4 Press down on the width guide tab and slide the  
width guide to the far right side of the input tray  
as shown.  
Width Guide Tab  
Width Guide  
5 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, then  
fan them. Do not fold or crease the paper.  
Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
For this setup, load letter-size paper.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6 Place the paper against the left side of the input  
tray and insert it under the metal stop.  
Make sure the recommended print side is face down  
and the front edge is placed toward the front of the  
input tray.  
For information on how to load letterhead, see  
Metal Stop  
Note: Make sure the paper fits  
easily under the metal stop and  
is not bent or wrinkled. Do not  
raise the metal stop or force  
paper under the metal stop.  
Overfilling the input tray may  
cause paper jams.  
7 Do not exceed the maximum stack height indi-  
cated by the line under the arrows.  
Stack Height  
Indicator  
Note: Overfilling the input tray  
may cause paper jams.  
Loading the Standard Input Tray  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
8 Push on the right side of the width guide to move  
it to the left until it lightly touches the edge of the  
paper.  
Width Guide  
Note: Sliding the width guide  
too tight against the paper may  
cause misfeeds.  
9 Slide the input tray all the way into the printer  
until it snaps into place.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Installing the The paper bail helps prevent offset bin stacking by guid-  
ing print material into the standard output bin.  
Paper Bail  
The paper bail consists of two parts: a plastic bracket  
already installed on the printer and a metal bail.  
Complete the following steps to install the metal bail:  
1 Locate the metal bail that comes with your printer.  
2 Orient the metal bail as shown.  
3 Place the tips of the metal bail into the holes  
Plastic Bracket  
located on either end of the plastic bracket as  
Metal Bail  
shown.  
Note: The paper bail is not  
depicted in other illustrations  
throughout this book now that  
you have installed it.  
Installing the Paper Bail  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Connecting Your To print from your computer, you need to connect your  
printer to your computer with either a parallel interface  
cable or a Universal Serial Bus (USB) cable.  
Printer to a  
Computer  
Using a  
Parallel Cable  
Your printer uses an IEEE 1284-compliant parallel cable  
that supports bidirectional communication. We recom-  
mend Lexmark part number 1329605 (10 ft) or  
1427498 (20 ft). If you use a cable other than an IEEE-com-  
pliant cable, you may not be able to access all of your  
printer functions.  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O) and unplug the  
printer power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Caution! To avoid electrical  
shock hazards, make sure your  
computer power is Off (O) and  
unplug all computer equipment  
before connecting cables.  
2 Align and plug the parallel cable into the parallel  
connector as shown.  
Parallel  
Cable  
Parallel Connector  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3 Push the clips at each end of the connector down  
into the notches on the plug as shown. The clips  
snap into the notches.  
4 Connect the other end of the parallel cable to the  
back of your computer. Tighten the screws on the  
parallel cable to the computer.  
5 Check the parallel cable connections to make sure  
they are completely secured.  
Clips  
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using a USB Cable  
Your printer has one standard USB port located on the  
printer system board.  
Complete the following steps to connect your printer  
using a USB cable.  
For Windows 2000 users:  
1 Make sure the computer and printer power are Off  
(O) and the printer power cord is unplugged from  
the electrical outlet.  
2 Connect the USB cable to the port on the back of  
your computer.  
3 Connect the other end of the cable to the USB port  
on the back of your printer.  
4 Turn on your computer and your printer.  
5 When the Found New Hardware Wizard screen  
appears, select Cancel to close the wizard.  
USB  
Cable  
6 Insert the CD that came with your printer and  
select Start.  
7 From the Start menu, select Run, then click Browse.  
8 Click on the My Computer shortcut in the Browse  
window, double-click on the CD icon, and double-  
click on the Setup icon.  
USB Port  
9
Click OK to start the printer driver installation  
program.  
10 Follow the installation instructions in the printer  
drivers dialog box.  
11 In the Print to the following port check box, select  
the USB port that best describes the order youve  
connected USB printers to your computer (for  
example, the first USB printer is USB001, the sec-  
ond USB002, and so on).  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
12 In the Select a port for this printer check box, select  
the USB port that best describes the order  
youve connected USB printers to your com-  
puter (for example, the first USB printer is  
USB001, the second USB002, and so on).  
13 When you finish, exit the setup program and  
remove the CD from your computer.  
For Windows 98 users:  
1 Make sure the printer power is Off (O) and the  
printer power cord is unplugged from the electri-  
cal outlet.  
2 Align and plug the USB cable into the USB port on  
the back of your printer as shown.  
3 Connect the other end of the USB cable to the back  
of your computer.  
USB  
Cable  
4 Check the cable connections to make sure they are  
completely secured.  
5 Follow the steps under Plugging the Printer In”  
USB Port  
6 Follow the steps under Turning the Printer Power  
7 Complete the following steps to setup the printer  
port and install the correct drivers.  
When you turn the printer power On (| ), the Add  
New Hardware Wizard screen appears on your com-  
puter.  
a Click Next.  
b Click the default to search for the best driver.  
Click Next.  
c Click to clear the check boxes for Floppy Disk or  
CD-ROM.  
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
d Insert the compact disc (CD) that came with  
your printer.  
e Click Specify a location.  
f
Click Browse.  
g Scroll down until you locate your CD-ROM  
drive. Double-click to select it.  
h Highlight the folder for WIN98USB and click  
OK.  
i
Click Next.  
A screen displays indicating the application is  
looking for this laser printer to verify the driver  
for the printer.  
j
Click Next.  
Wait as the information processes. When the next  
screen appears that tells you the software is  
installed, click Finish. Complete the following to  
install the printer driver.  
k Click Install Software.  
l
Click Printer Software.  
The Choose your Installation Path screen  
displays.  
m Select Install from this CD.  
The License Agreement displays.  
n Click Agree once you have read the agreement.  
o Select Custom Install and click Next.  
Printer Drivers is selected as the default on the  
next screen.  
p Click Next.  
q Scroll through the list of printers on the left of  
the screen and click the check box to select  
Optra M410 or Optra M412.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
r Click the Add button.  
The name of your printer moves to the box on  
the right of the screen.  
s Click Next.  
The Drivers tab screen displays.  
t
Highlight LPT1 in the top window of the screen  
for the PostScript language.  
u Scroll to USB001 in the bottom window of the  
screen and select it.  
v Return to the top window of the screen and  
select LPT1 for the PCL language.  
w Scroll to USB001 in the bottom window of the  
screen and select it.  
x Click Finish Installation.  
Wait as the information processes.  
y Click Yes to restart Windows.  
z Click OK.  
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For Macintosh users:  
1 Make sure the printer power is Off (O) and the  
printer power cord is unplugged from the electri-  
cal outlet.  
2 Connect the end of the USB cable to the port on  
your computer.  
3 Align and plug the other end of the USB cable into  
the port on the back of your printer as shown.  
4 Follow the steps under Plugging the Printer In”  
USB  
Cable  
5 Follow the steps under Turning the Printer Power  
6 Launch the CD to install the necessary items.  
Instructions to launch the CD are in the CD  
booklet.  
USB Port  
7 Restart the computer.  
8 Open the Apples Extras folder.  
9 Open the Apple LaserWriter Software folder.  
10 Open the Desktop Printer Utility application.  
11 The New Desktop Printer screen displays.  
12 Select Printer (USB) from the list and click OK.  
13 In the USB printer selection area, click Change.  
The USB printer dialog box displays.  
14 Select Optra M410 or Optra M412 and click OK.  
The previous screen displays. Notice the new  
printer icon.  
15 In the PostScript printer description (PPD) file,  
click Auto Setup.  
Wait for the information to process.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
The previous screen displays. Notice the new  
printer icon.  
Note: Both areas of the printer  
dialog box show the Optra M410  
or Optra M412 printer icons.  
16 Click Create.  
A window appears for you to name the printer.  
17 Type in the name of the printer or accept the  
default name.  
18 Click Save.  
19 Quit the Desktop Printer Utility application.  
The printer icon displays on your Desktop.  
20 Click the new desktop printer icon.  
The Printing menu appears on the menu bar.  
21 Scroll down in the Printing menu and select Set  
Default Printer.  
A dark line appears around the printer in the  
printer icon to indicate it is selected as the default  
printer.  
Connecting Your Printer to a Computer  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Plugging the  
Printer In  
1 Plug the printer power cord into the connector as  
shown.  
2 Plug the other end of the printer power cord into a  
properly grounded electrical outlet.  
Printer  
Power Cord  
Turning the Printer Turn the printer power On (| ).  
Power On  
If an error message displays, see Understanding Printer  
Messageson page 151 for more information.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Printing the Menu The menu settings page shows current settings for the  
menus, a list of installed options, and available printer  
Settings Page  
memory. You can use this page to verify that all printer  
options are properly installed and the printer settings are  
set to what you want.  
Warning! CompleteRemoving  
page 2 before printing a page.  
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the  
Ready status message appears on the display.  
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.  
3 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until  
you see UTILITIES MENU on the second line of the  
display.  
Note: See Using the  
4 Press Select.  
identify the display and operator  
panel buttons if you need help.  
5 Press Menu> until Print Menus appears on the sec-  
ond line of the display.  
6 Press Select.  
The message Printing Menu Settings appears and  
remains on the operator panel display until the  
page prints. The printer returns to the Ready state  
after the menu settings page prints.  
If an error message appears, see Understanding Printer  
Messageson page 151 for more information.  
Printing the Menu Settings Page  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Installing the If English is your preferred language, continue with  
Operator Panel  
If English is not your preferred language, complete the fol-  
lowing steps to customize the operator panel.  
Overlay  
1 Locate the operator panel overlay.  
If this Users Guide is printed in a language other  
than English, an overlay for the operator panel is  
included with the printer. The overlay has trans-  
lated names for the operator panel buttons.  
2 Peel the protective backing off the overlay.  
3 Align the operator panel overlay on the operator  
panel and press it into place as shown.  
Rub the overlay firmly to make sure that it adheres  
securely.  
4 Peel the protective covering away from the top of  
the overlay.  
play Languageon page 23 to change the display  
language to match the overlay.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Changing the Complete the following steps to change the language of  
the menus and messages that appear on the operator  
panel display:  
Operator Panel  
Display Language  
1 Press the Menu> or <Menu button to enter the  
menus.  
2 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until  
SETUP MENU appears on the second line of the dis-  
play.  
Note: The Select button acts  
upon information that appears  
3 Press the Select button.  
on the second line of the opera-  
tor panel display.  
4 Press Menu> until Display Language appears on the  
second line of the display.  
5 Press Select.  
Note: See Using the  
6 Press Menu> until your preferred language appears  
identify the display and operator  
panel buttons if you need help.  
on the second line of the display.  
7 Press Select.  
The printer resets and displays text in the requested  
language.  
Changing the Operator Panel Display Language  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Installing Printer  
Drivers and  
Utilities  
1 Locate the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD  
that comes with your printer.  
If your computer does not have a CD-ROM drive,  
you can transfer the information on the CD to dis-  
kettes. Locate a computer with a CD-ROM drive,  
start the CD-ROM utility, and follow the instruc-  
tions presented to create diskettes.  
Note: Consult your network  
software documentation for  
more information. Also, see  
page 25 for more information.  
2 Follow the instructions in the booklet included  
with the CD to start the printer setup utility.  
The setup utility lets you install printer drivers and  
utilities to manage Lexmark printers attached to  
page 25 for more information.  
3 If necessary, use standard network software to  
identify the printer to the LAN and to complete  
any other setup that may be needed.  
Chapter 1: Setting Up Your Printer  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
MarkVision  
2
MarkVision Printer This section provides a brief overview of the MarkVision  
printer utility and some of its key features. For more infor-  
Management  
mation on MarkVision, refer to the online Help or the doc-  
umentation on the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD that  
comes with your printer:  
Software  
Introduction to MarkVision  
Installation Tips  
Operating Systems  
Supported  
MarkVision for Windows 95/ 98/ 2000, Windows NT 4.0,  
Macintosh, and OS/ 2 Warp is shipped with your printer  
on the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD.  
Introducing  
MarkVision  
The MarkVision graphical user interface provides  
advanced, real-time, centralized management capabilities  
for Lexmark printers connected locally or attached  
directly to a network. Network users and administrators  
can also use the following MarkVision features to increase  
productivity:  
Centralized setup capabilities let you quickly con-  
figure and install multiple printers.  
You can configure multiple printers simulta-  
neously from one workstation.  
Automatic network printer discovery and multi-  
adapter flash update let you set up and configure  
MarkVision Printer Management Software  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Lexmark network printers and change network  
addresses from one workstation.  
Use MarkVision to easily manage and monitor your  
Lexmark printers.  
Note: You can integrate  
MarkVision directly into your  
favorite network management  
software.  
Messages on the MarkVision remote operator  
panel reflect printer real-time status.  
The dynamic printer graphic provides a visual  
confirmation of installed options.  
A list of installed features shows you printer  
capabilities.  
MarkVision provides the tools to make printer-  
related administrative tasks effortless.  
Note: Management capabili-  
ties for multivendor printers are  
available in some versions of  
MarkVision.  
Monitor network print jobs, change their print-  
ing order, and hold or delete specific jobs.  
Use asset management options to maintain  
printer inventory, assign property tags, track  
page counts, and gather job statistics.  
Download and manage resources such as fonts,  
demo pages, and overlays.  
MarkVision for This section provides a brief overview of MarkVision for  
Intranet Servers and some of its key features. For more  
information on MarkVision for Intranet Servers, refer to  
the documentation installed with the software:  
Intranet Servers  
MarkVision for Intranets Users Guide.  
MarkVision Installation and Configuration Guide.  
This document is also located on the Drivers,  
MarkVision and Utilities CD that comes with your  
printer.  
Introducing  
MarkVision for  
Intranet Servers  
MarkVision for Intranet Servers is a Web-based printer  
management utility that:  
Lets you monitor and manage devices using a Web  
browser from any PC with intranet access.  
Chapter 2: MarkVision  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Enables print management over your existing intra-  
net infrastructure using TCP/ IP.  
Offers a cross-platform solution for Windows and  
UNIX users.  
Lets you manage multivendor printers.  
Network users and administrators can also use the follow-  
ing MarkVision features to increase productivity.  
Maps  
Locate printers quickly in your organization by position-  
ing printer icons on a map to show not only printer status,  
but also actual printer location.  
Filters  
Search for devices using criteria such as printer status and  
installed features.  
Filters automatically organize printers into groups based  
on real-time status information.  
Remote Updates  
Remotely update firmware on multiple Lexmark print  
servers simultaneously.  
MarkVision for MarkVision for UNIX/ Sun offers enterprise scalability,  
reliability, and performance that helps you easily set up,  
UNIX Networks  
manage, and maintain printers across networks. Ulti-  
mately, this reduces help desk costs and increases network  
administrator productivity using:  
Centralized Lexmark printer setup capabilities.  
Remote monitoring and management.  
Proactive status alerts on Lexmark printers.  
Tools that allocate printing expenses, balance work-  
load, and access printing resources.  
MarkVision for UNIX Networks  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
MarkVision Simple Network Management Protocol  
(SNMP) Services let administrators manage popular mul-  
tivendor printers.  
MarkVision for UNIX Networks and Intranet Servers is  
recommended to assist in remote printer setup for UNIX  
platforms.  
To purchase MarkVision for UNIX, contact the place  
where you bought your printer or visit the Lexmark Web  
site at www.lexmark.com.  
Lexmark MarkTrackis a network printer reporting software  
package that helps administrators manage printing envi-  
ronments more efficiently. Administrators can use Mark-  
Track to:  
MarkTrack  
Retrieve and analyze network printer information  
from a Web browser.  
Allocate printing resources more efficiently.  
Make better purchasing decisions.  
Allocate printing costs to different departments.  
Provide statistical information on employee print-  
ing habits.  
Track Lexmark and SNMP-compliant printers.  
Collect, analyze, and create reports using MarkVi-  
sion Printer Inventory and Job Statistics data or  
SNMP MIB data.  
Create reports using a Web server.  
View reports using a Web browser.  
Create an inventory of network printer assets auto-  
matically.  
Analyze printing for the enterprise.  
Plan ahead for supplies purchases, maintenance  
schedules, and printer replacement.  
For more information on MarkTrack, refer to the product  
information, contact the place where you bought your  
Chapter 2: MarkVision  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
printer, or visit the Lexmark Web site at  
www.lexmark.com.  
Lexmark NetPnP NetPnP automates the configuration and installation of  
Lexmark printers on a network. NetPnP senses when a  
new printer is attached to the network, automatically cre-  
ates a shared printer object on a Windows NT 4.0 system,  
and notifies users by e-mail that the printer is available for  
printing. It also notifies IT administrators by e-mail when  
a new printer is detected or when an error occurs during  
automatic printer installation.  
Lets administrators make printers available to users  
within seconds.  
Extends network printer installation to include the  
end user by installing all necessary components that  
enable printing to workstations across the network.  
Provides huge productivity gains when rolling out  
large numbers of network printers.  
Supports a wide range of printer installation  
options for IT administrators, from fully automatic  
installation to prompted confirmations.  
Lets you customize network printer installation in  
Windows NT environments running TCP/ IP.  
Automates the setup of Lexmark network printers,  
eliminating more than a dozen steps in the process.  
Software On the Drivers, MarkVision and Utilities CD, Lexmark's all-  
in-one software installation utility provides IT administra-  
tors with time-saving installation and distribution tools  
that enhance productivity and improve efficiency.  
Installation and  
Distribution Tools  
Software installation and updates by way of the  
Lexmark Web site.  
Users can initiate Web updates or schedule updates  
to run periodically. This ensures that users have the  
most recent version of Lexmark software and driv-  
Lexmark NetPnP  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ers on their workstations with the least amount of  
effort.  
Scripting capability to distribute software to users  
on the network.  
IT administrators can store software and driver  
installation settings in a file. This file can then be  
used to automatically distribute the software to  
multiple workstations simultaneously.  
Distribution of drivers with custom settings to  
users.  
IT administrators can remotely install, update, and  
distribute drivers with custom settings to users on  
the network, eliminating time-consuming worksta-  
tion driver installation and configuration.  
Optra Forms Optra Forms combines data from a customers application  
with printer-resident electronic forms to produce com-  
pleted forms such as invoices, statements, pick slips,  
labels, and purchase orders. Support for bar codes, spe-  
cialized graphics and other options is included.  
The same data can be sent to several remote printers with  
different resident forms so that the completed forms can  
be customized for the specific printer location. For exam-  
ple, the same purchase order information can be sent to  
different printers and printed with different addresses and  
logos.  
Optra Forms:  
Requires no server-based or host-based merge pro-  
gram or software.  
Can be used:  
With virtually any ASCII text print file from any  
platform, mainframe, AS/ 400, UNIX or worksta-  
tion.  
Over Coax, Twinax, parallel, serial or LAN  
(TCP/ IP).  
Generally makes no changes to database applica-  
tions.  
Chapter 2: MarkVision  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Prints different forms at different locations from the  
same database.  
Globally updates forms quickly and easily over the  
LAN.  
Provides support for bar codes, color, duplex, multi-  
page form sets, and more.  
Stores forms as efficient, compact forms in flash.  
Works with Optra M410 and M412 printers and the  
Optra T and Optra W laser printer families using  
the Optra Forms1, 2, 4, 8, and 16MB Flash  
DIMMs or Optra Forms Hard Disk.  
Solaris Ready Solaris Ready printers are specially configured for Sun  
users. They are Ethernet-ready and include Sun-specific  
documentation as well as MarkVision for Sun Systems  
and Intranet Servers. These applications provide seamless  
installation in Sun Solaris network environments.  
Printers for Sun  
Customers  
Solaris Ready Printers for Sun Customers  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 2: MarkVision  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the  
Operator Panel  
and Menus  
3
This chapter contains information about using the  
operator panel, changing printer settings, and under-  
standing operator panel menus.  
You can change most printer settings from your software  
application or printer driver. Settings you change from the  
application or driver apply only to the job you are prepar-  
ing to send to the printer.  
If there is a setting you cannot change from your software  
application, use the operator panel or the remote operator  
panel available from the MarkVision utility. See MarkVi-  
sionon page 25 for information about MarkVision.  
Changing a printer setting from the operator panel or  
from MarkVision makes that setting the user default.  
Note: Changes made to  
printer settings from a software  
application override changes  
made from the operator panel.  
If you are familiar with using an operator panel similar to  
this, you may want to skip to Overview of  
Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Using the The operator panel, on the front left-side of your printer,  
has a 2-line by 16-character liquid crystal display (LCD),  
Operator Panel  
one printer indicator light, and six buttons. Notice the  
Menu button is split into two functioning halves; there-  
fore, it works like two buttons.  
The numbers on the operator panel by the names of the  
buttons are only used for entering your Personal Identifi-  
cation Number (PIN) if you send a print job that is confi-  
dential. For more information, see CONFIDENTIAL JOB on  
LCD  
Menu  
Select  
Return  
Go  
Stop  
Printer Indicator Light  
Printer Indicator  
Light  
The printer indicator light gives information about the  
status of your printer.  
Light State  
On Solid  
Blinking  
Off  
Meaning  
The printer is On (|) and in the Ready state.  
The printer is On (|) and Busy.  
The printer is Off (O).  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Operator Panel  
Buttons  
Use the operator panel buttons to open a menu, scroll  
through a list of values, change printer settings, respond  
to printer messages, temporarily stop all print activity,  
and key in a PIN. The following table describes the func-  
tions of each button.  
If this Users Guide is printed in a language other than  
English, an operator panel overlay with translated buttons  
and light names is included with your printer. See Install-  
information.  
Note: Buttons act upon the  
information that displays on the  
second line of the operator  
panel except when using the  
buttons to key in a PIN.  
Operator Panel Buttons  
Button  
Go  
Function  
Press the Go button to:  
Return to the Ready state if the printer is in an offline situation (the Ready message does not  
appear on the display).  
Exit printer menus and return to the Ready state.  
Clear operator panel error messages.  
Resume printing after loading print material and clearing paper jams.  
Exit Power Saver.  
If you have changed printer settings from the operator panel menus, press Go before sending a  
job to print. The printer must display Ready for jobs to print.  
Menu> and  
Each end of the button has a function. Press the Menu> or <Menu button:  
<Menu  
At the Ready message, to take the printer offline (out of the Ready state) and enter the  
menus. Menu> takes you to the first menu in the menus. <Menu takes you to the last menu in  
the menus.  
At the Busy message, to list the menu items in the JOB MENU.  
When the printer is offline:  
-
-
Press Menu> to go to the next item in the menus, or  
Press <Menu to go to the previous item in the menus.  
For menu items that have numerical values, such as Copies, press and hold Menu> to scroll  
forward, or <Menu to scroll backward. Release the button when the number you want  
displays.  
Using the Operator Panel  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Operator Panel Buttons (continued)  
Button  
Select  
Function  
Press the Select button to:  
Select the menu shown on the second line of the display. Depending on the type of menu, this  
action:  
-
-
Opens the menu and displays the first item in the menu.  
Opens the menu item and displays the default setting.  
Save the displayed menu item as the new default setting. The printer displays the Saved  
message briefly and returns to the menu item.  
Clear certain messages from the operator panel display.  
Continue printing after the Change <input source> message displays. See Change <input  
source> on page 167 for more information.  
Return  
Stop  
Press the Return button to return to the previous menu level or menu item.  
Press the Stop button at the Ready, Busy, or Waiting message to temporarily stop all activity  
and take the printer offline. The operator panel status message changes to Not Ready. No data  
is lost.  
Press Go to return the printer to the Ready, Busy, or Waiting state.  
1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6  
The numbers located next to the names of the buttons are only used for entering your Personal  
Identification Number (PIN) after you send a Confidential Job. For more information, see  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Printer Messages The operator panel displays three types of messages:  
Status messages provide information about the  
current state of the printer.  
for a complete listing of all the  
printer messages.  
Attendance messages report printer errors that you  
must resolve.  
Service messages indicate printer failures that may  
require servicing.  
Status Messages  
When the Ready status message displays, the printer is  
ready to receive a print job. While a job is processing or  
printing, the Busy status message or a customized mes-  
sage appears on the first line of the operator panel display.  
The screen to the left is an example of an operator panel  
message. The printer status appears on the first line of the  
display. The second line displays messages, such as warn-  
ing messages, that give more information about printer  
status.  
Busy  
Parallel  
PCL  
The Busy message identifies the printer language  
(PCL emulation) used for the print job. The Parallel mes-  
sage tells you that the printer is processing data received  
by the parallel port.  
Attendance  
Messages  
Attendance messages help you solve printer problems.  
For example, if print material is jammed in the printer, the  
message 200 Paper Jam Remove Cartridge appears on the  
display.  
This message tells you to open the printer upper front  
door and check for jammed print material.  
200 Paper Jam  
Remove Cartridge  
Service Messages  
Service messages notify you of printer failures that may  
require a service call.  
Printer Messages  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                         
Operator Panel A number of menus are available to make it easy for you  
to change printer settings. The diagram on page 43 shows  
Menus  
the menus and all of the menu items available in each  
menu. The items in each menu and the values you can  
select are described in more detail in the tables beginning  
Some menus appear only if a specific option is installed in  
the printer. Other menu items may only be effective for a  
particular printer language. You can select these values at  
any time, but they only affect printer function when you  
use the specified printer language.  
An asterisk (*) next to a value in the tables indicates the  
factory default setting. These settings are the original printer  
settings. (Factory defaults may vary for different coun-  
tries.) See Factory Defaults on page 57 or on page 107 for  
more information.  
Note: Changes made from a  
software application or driver  
override the user default settings  
made from the operator panel.  
When you select a new setting from the operator panel,  
the asterisk moves next to the selected setting to identify it  
as the current user default setting. These settings are active  
until new ones are stored or the factory defaults are  
more information.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Printing the Menu  
Settings Page  
The menu settings page shows current settings for the  
menus, a list of installed options, and available printer  
memory. You can use this page to verify that the printer  
options are properly installed and the printer settings are  
set to what you want.  
display and operator panel buttons if you need help.  
To print a menu settings page:  
Note: Before printing the  
menu settings page, make sure  
the selected paper source holds  
letter-, legal-, or A4-size paper,  
the PAPER SIZE setting is set to  
the correct size, and the PAPER  
TYPE setting for the paper  
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the  
Ready status message appears on the display.  
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.  
3 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until  
you see UTILITIES MENU on the second line of the  
display.  
source is Plain Paper.  
4 Press Select.  
5 Press Menu> until Print Menus appears on the sec-  
ond line of the display.  
6 Press Select.  
The message Printing Menu Settings appears and  
remains on the operator panel display until the  
page prints. The printer returns to the Ready state  
after the menu settings page prints.  
If an error message appears on the display, see  
7 If you installed options, verify that they are listed  
on the menu settings page under Installed Fea-  
tures.”  
If an option you installed does not appear on the  
page, turn the printer power Off (O), unplug the  
printer power cord, reinstall the option, and print  
the menu settings page again.  
Operator Panel Menus  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Changing  
Menu Settings  
You can use the operator panel to change printer settings  
and customize your printer to meet your specific needs.  
To select a new value as the default setting:  
1 From the Ready state, press Menu> or <Menu to enter  
the menus.  
Note: Changes made from a  
software application override the  
user default settings made from  
the operator panel.  
2 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until  
the menu you need appears on the second line of  
the display.  
list of the menus and their menu items.  
3 Press Select.  
The menu opens and the first menu item in the  
menu appears on the second line of the display.  
4 Press Menu> or <Menu until the menu item you  
need appears on the second line of the display.  
5 Press Select.  
An asterisk (*) appears beside the current user  
default setting for that menu item.  
Some menu items have submenus. For example, if  
you select PAPER MENU, and then select the PAPER  
TYPE menu item, you must select another menu  
(such as Tray 1 Type) before the available values dis-  
play.  
A value can be:  
An On or Off setting.  
A phrase or word that describes a setting.  
A numerical value that you can increase or  
decrease.  
6 Press Menu> or <Menu until the value you need  
appears on the second line of the display.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Note: User default settings  
remain in effect until you save  
new settings or restore the fac-  
tory defaults.  
7 Press Select.  
An asterisk (*) appears beside the value to indicate  
that it is now the user default setting. The display  
shows the new setting for one second and then  
clears. The Saved message displays, then the previ-  
ous list of menu items appears on the operator  
panel display.  
8 Press Return to go back to previous menus or menu  
items and set new default settings.  
9 Press Go to return to Ready if this is the last printer  
setting you want to change.  
Disabling the  
Operator Panel  
Menus  
To disable the menus so that changes cannot be made to  
the printer default settings:  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).  
Note: When the operator  
panel menus are disabled,  
access to the JOB MENU is per-  
mitted from the Ready and Power  
Saver states. Access to the CON-  
FIDENTIAL JOB and HELD JOBS  
menu items is permitted from  
the Ready state only.  
2 Press and hold the Select and Return buttons and  
turn the printer power On (| ).  
3 Release the buttons when Performing Self Test  
appears on the operator panel display.  
When the printer self test completes, the CONFIG  
MENU displays.  
4 Press Menu> until Panel Menus displays on the sec-  
ond line.  
5 Press Select.  
6 Press Menu> until Disable displays on the second  
line of the display.  
7 Press Select.  
Operator Panel Menus  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
8 The Saved message briefly appears, then Disabling  
Menus displays.  
The CONFIG MENU displays again with Panel Menus  
on the second line.  
9 Press Menu> until Exit Config Menu displays on the  
second line.  
10 Press Select.  
Activating Menu Changes briefly appears, and then  
Performing Self Test briefly appears. The printer  
returns to the Ready state.  
To enable the menus, repeat the previous steps and select  
Enable instead of Disable.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Overview of  
Printer Menus  
Menus or menu items in italics only appear on the display if the  
corresponding option is installed. Capitalized menu items (for  
example, PAPER SIZE) have submenus. See the tables on the  
following pages for a list of the values for each menu item.  
PAPER MENU  
FINISHING MENU  
UTILITIES MENU  
JOB MENU  
QUALITY MENU  
Paper Source  
Copies  
Print Menus  
Cancel Job  
Print Resolution  
Toner Darkness  
PQET  
PAPER SIZE  
Blank Pages  
Print Net1 Setup  
Print Fonts  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
HELD JOBS  
PAPER TYPE  
Collation  
CUSTOM TYPES  
Substitute Size  
Configure MP  
Separator Sheets  
Separator Source  
Multipage Print  
Multipage Order  
Multipage View  
Multipage Border  
Print Directory  
Factory Defaults  
Format Flash  
Defragment Flash  
Format Disk  
Job Acct Stat  
Hex Trace  
Reset Printer  
Print Buffer  
PictureGrade  
PAPER TEXTURE  
PAPER WEIGHT  
PAPER LENGTH  
SETUP MENU  
PCL EMUL MENU  
POSTSCRIPT  
PARALLEL MENU  
SERIAL MENU  
Printer Language  
Font Source  
Font Name  
Print PS Error  
Font Priority  
STD PARALLEL  
SERIAL OPTION 1  
1
Power Saver  
PARALLEL OPT 1  
PCL SmartSwitch  
PS SmartSwitch  
NPA Mode  
Resource Save  
Download Target  
Print Timeout  
Wait Timeout  
Auto Continue  
Jam Recovery  
Page Protect  
Point Size  
PCL SmartSwitch  
PS SmartSwitch  
NPA Mode  
Parallel Buffer  
Job Buffering  
Advanced Status  
Protocol  
Pitch  
Symbol Set  
Orientation  
Lines Per Page  
A4 Width  
TRAY RENUMBER  
Auto CR after LF  
Auto LF after CR  
Serial Buffer  
RS-232/RS-422  
RS-422 Polarity  
Serial Protocol  
Robust XON  
Baud  
Print Area  
Honor Init  
2
Display Language  
Alarm Control  
Job Buffer Size  
Job Accounting  
Job Acct Limit  
Parallel Mode 1  
Data Bits  
Parallel Mode 2  
Parity  
Honor DSR  
USB MENU  
FAX MENU  
NETWORK MENU  
LOCALTALK MENU  
INFRARED MENU  
STANDARD USB  
USB OPTION 1  
Fax Port  
NETWORK OPTION 1  
LocalTalk Port  
PCL SmartSwitch  
PS SmartSwitch  
NPA Mode  
Infrared Port  
Fax Baud  
PCL SmartSwitch  
PS SmartSwitch  
NPA Mode  
PCL SmartSwitch  
PS SmartSwitch  
NPA Mode  
Network Buffer  
Network 1 Setup  
Fax Data Bits  
Fax Parity  
Fax Buffer  
Fax Paper Size  
Fax Paper Type  
PCL SmartSwitch  
PS SmartSwitch  
NPA Mode  
USB Buffer  
Job Buffering  
LocalTalk Buffer  
NPA Hosts  
Infrared Buffer  
Window Size  
Transmit Delay  
Max Baud Rate  
LocalTalk Name  
LocalTalk Addr  
LocalTalk Zone  
1
CONFIG MENU  
Some printer models released in the year 2000 or later designated as Energy Star printers cannot  
have Power Saver disabled.  
2 Parallel Mode 1 is not supported on the Optra M412 printer.  
For all menus:  
Prt Quality Pgs  
Panel Menus  
Buffered Jobs  
Factory Defaults  
NARROW MEDIA  
Exit Config Menu  
Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus and scroll through the options.  
Press Select to choose a menu, menu item, or value.  
Press Return to back up to the previous menu level.  
For all menus except CONFIG MENU:  
Press Go to return to Ready.  
Operator Panel Menus  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper Menu  
Use the PAPER MENU to define all settings relating to  
print material input and output, as well as the specific  
print material you are using with your printer.  
Paper Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Paper Source  
Tray 1*  
Tray 2  
MP Feeder  
Manual Paper  
Manual Env  
The Paper Source setting identifies the default paper source.  
Tray 2 is available only if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed. See Optional 500-Sheet  
Draweron page 223 for more information.  
Select Manual Paper when manually feeding a sheet of print material other than an envelope  
through the multipurpose feeder.  
Select Manual Env when manually feeding an envelope through the multipurpose feeder.  
MP Feeder displays only if Configure MP is set to Cassette. If Paper Source is set to  
MP Feeder and Configure MP is set to First, the Paper Source setting automatically changes  
to Tray 1.  
If you are using the same size and type of print material in two paper sources (and the Paper  
Size and Paper Type settings are correctly set), the trays are automatically linked. When one  
paper source is empty, print material automatically feeds from the other paper source. See  
Tray Linkingon page 135 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER SIZE  
Tray 1 Size  
Tray 2 Size  
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:  
A4* (Country specific)  
JIS B5  
Letter* (Country specific)  
Legal  
Executive  
MP Feeder Size  
A4* (Country specific)  
A5  
JIS B5  
Letter* (Country specific)  
Legal  
Executive  
Universal  
7 ¾ Envelope  
9 Envelope  
10 Envelope  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER SIZE  
(continued)  
Manual Pap Size  
A4* (Country specific)  
A5  
JIS B5  
Letter* (Country specific)  
Legal  
Executive  
Universal  
Manual Env Size  
7 ¾ Envelope  
9 Envelope  
10 Envelope* (Country specific)  
DL Envelope* (Country specific)  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
The PAPER SIZE setting identifies the default formatting size for each paper source. See the  
tables beginning on page 116 for a list of the dimensions for each paper and envelope size.  
Note: Before loading print material in any paper source, make sure you select the  
PAPER SIZE, PAPER TYPE, PAPER TEXTURE, PAPER WEIGHT, and PAPER LENGTH from  
the operator panel for the paper source. Also, select the paper size and type from your  
software application for the print material you are loading.  
Select Manual Pap Size when manually feeding a single sheet of print material other than an  
envelope through the multipurpose feeder.  
Select Manual Env Size when manually feeding a single envelope through the multipurpose  
feeder.  
Universal refers to any size that is not considered a standard size. Select Universal from the  
PAPER SIZE menu when you load print material that does not match any of the other available  
sizes. The printer automatically formats the page for the maximum possible size. You can then  
set the actual page size from your application.  
Select Other Envelope from the PAPER SIZE menu when you load envelopes that do not  
match any of the other available sizes. The printer automatically formats for the maximum  
possible envelope size. You can then set the actual envelope size from your application.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER TYPE  
Tray 1 Type  
Tray 2 Type  
Manual Pap Type  
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:  
Plain Paper*  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Labels  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Custom Type 1  
Custom Type 2*  
Custom Type 3  
Custom Type 4  
Custom Type 5  
Custom Type 6  
Note: Plain Paper is the default setting for Tray 1 Type and Manual Pap Type. Custom Type 2  
is the default for Tray 2 Type.  
MP Feeder Type  
Plain Paper  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Labels  
Bond  
Envelope  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Custom Type 1  
Custom Type 2  
Custom Type 3  
Custom Type 4  
Custom Type 5  
Custom Type 6*  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER TYPE  
(continued)  
Manual Env Type  
Envelope*  
Custom Type 1  
Custom Type 2  
Custom Type 3  
Custom Type 4  
Custom Type 5  
Custom Type 6  
The PAPER TYPE setting lets you specify the type of print material installed in each paper  
source. This setting is used by the printer in the following ways:  
Enables the printer to optimize print quality for the specified print material.  
Enables you to select paper sources through your software application by selecting only a  
type and size. A source selection is unnecessary.  
Enables the printer to automatically link paper sources. Any sources that contain the same  
type and size of print material are automatically linked by the printer if you have set the  
PAPER SIZE and the PAPER TYPE to the correct settings for the paper sources. See Tray  
Linkingon page 135 for more information.  
Select Manual Pap Type when manually feeding a single sheet of print material through the  
multipurpose feeder.  
Select Manual Env Type when manually feeding an envelope through the multipurpose feeder.  
Note: Before loading print material in any paper source, make sure you select the  
PAPER SIZE, PAPER TYPE, PAPER TEXTURE, PAPER WEIGHT, and PAPER LENGTH from  
the operator panel for the paper source. Also, select the paper size and the type from your  
application for the print material you are loading.  
Custom Type 1 through 6 refers to special types of print materials. You can change the names  
through a utility, such as MarkVision. For more information on setting the Custom Type  
names, see CUSTOM TYPES on page 49.  
If you are using different print material in the paper sources, each source with a different print  
material must have the PAPER SIZE and PAPER TYPE set to a unique value to disable the  
automatic tray linking feature. Otherwise, if a paper source becomes empty, the printer selects  
print material from another source since the printer sees the trays as linked. This might cause  
a one-page letter to print on a sheet of labels or on a transparency. See Tray Linkingon  
page 135 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
CUSTOM TYPES  
Custom Type x (where x represents a custom type from 1 to 6)  
Paper*  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Labels  
Envelope  
The CUSTOM TYPES setting identifies the kind of print material used for each of the Custom  
Types available in the PAPER TYPE menu item. This print material designation optimizes print  
quality settings when you select print material from a paper source when the type is set to  
Custom Type x. If a user-defined name is available, the name displays instead of  
Custom Type x, where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is  
truncated to 14 characters.  
Substitute Size  
Configure MP  
Off  
Letter/A4*  
Select Letter/A4 to let the printer automatically print A4-size jobs on letter-size paper and  
letter-size jobs on A4-size paper, if the requested size is not currently installed in the paper  
source.  
Cassette*  
Manual  
First  
When the multipurpose feeder is set to Cassette and the PAPER SIZE and PAPER TYPE  
settings are set correctly, the printer treats the multipurpose feeder like any other paper  
source. If a print job requests a size print material that is only loaded in the multipurpose  
feeder, the printer selects the print material from the multipurpose feeder for the print job.  
Select Manual to manually feed single sheets of print material through the multipurpose  
feeder. The multipurpose feeder acts like a manual feed slot and you can feed only one sheet  
of print material through at a time.  
If you set Configure MP to First, the printer feeds print material from the multipurpose feeder  
until it is empty, regardless of the paper source or paper size requested for the job.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER TEXTURE  
Plain Texture  
Card Stock Text  
Trnsprncy Text  
Labels Texture  
Bond Texture  
Envelope Texture  
Ltrhead Texture  
Preprint Texture  
Colored Texture  
Custom 1 Texture  
Custom 2 Texture  
Custom 3 Texture  
Custom 4 Texture  
Custom 5 Texture  
Custom 6 Texture  
Each of the above menu items support the following three values as a second menu:  
Smooth  
Normal*  
Rough  
Note: Rough is the factory default for Bond Texture.  
Select the appropriate PAPER TEXTURE value (Smooth, Normal, or Rough) for each  
PAPER TYPE, including the Custom Types, that you are using. Set the correct  
PAPER TEXTURE value for your print material to make sure characters print clearly, without  
dropouts or voids. If the characters on your printed page appear broken or poorly-formed, set  
PAPER TEXTURE to Rough. If characters on your printed page appear smeared, set  
PAPER TEXTURE to Smooth or Normal.  
The PAPER TEXTURE setting works in connection with the PAPER TYPE and PAPER WEIGHT  
settings. You may need to change those settings to optimize print quality for your specific print  
material.  
If a user-defined texture is available, its name displays as a value instead of  
Custom x Texture, where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is  
truncated to 14 characters.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER WEIGHT  
Plain Weight  
CardStock Weight  
Trnsprncy Weight  
Labels Weight  
Bond Weight  
Envelope Weight  
Ltrhead Weight  
Preprint Weight  
Colored Weight  
Custom 1 Weight  
Custom 2 Weight  
Custom 3 Weight  
Custom 4 Weight  
Custom 5 Weight  
Custom 6 Weight  
Each of the above menu items support the following three values as a second menu:  
Light  
Normal*  
Heavy  
Select the appropriate PAPER WEIGHT value (Light, Normal, or Heavy) for each  
PAPER TYPE, including the Custom Types, that you are using. Set the correct  
PAPER WEIGHT value for your print material to make sure the toner adheres properly to the  
page. If you have trouble with toner rubbing off the page, set PAPER WEIGHT to Heavy. If your  
printed pages are curling excessively, set PAPER WEIGHT to Normal or Light.  
The PAPER WEIGHT setting works in connection with the PAPER TYPE and PAPER TEXTURE  
settings. You may need to change those settings to optimize print quality for your specific print  
material.  
If a user-defined weight is available, its name displays as a value instead of Custom x Weight,  
where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is truncated to 14  
characters.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Paper Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
PAPER LENGTH  
Plain Length  
CardStock Length  
Trnsprncy Length  
Labels Length  
Bond Length  
Envelope Length  
Ltrhead Length  
Preprint Length  
Colored Length  
Custom 1 Length  
Custom 2 Length  
Custom 3 Length  
Custom 4 Length  
Custom 5 Length  
Custom 6 Length  
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:  
Short  
Normal*  
Select the appropriate PAPER LENGTH value (Normal or Short) for each printer paper type.  
Set the PAPER LENGTH value to Short if your print material is 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in  
length. Set the PAPER LENGTH value to Normal for all other print material.  
Print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length can only be fed through the multipurpose  
feeder and must exit to the rear output bin.  
Note: If PAPER LENGTH is set to Short and the rear output bin door is not open, your job will  
not print. See Open Rear Door on page 172 for more information.  
If a user-defined length is available, its name displays as a value instead of Custom x Length,  
where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is truncated to 14  
characters.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Finishing Menu  
Use the FINISHING MENU to define all settings relating  
to printer output.  
Finishing Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Copies  
1*999  
The Copies setting determines the number of copies printed for each page. The printer does  
not automatically collate the copies. For example, if you send three pages to print and set  
Copies to 2, the printer prints page 1, page 1, page 2, page 2, page 3, page 3.  
For information about how to use the Copies setting with the Collation setting, see Collation  
as follows.  
Blank Pages  
Do Not Print*  
Print  
Select Print to include application-generated blank pages with your print job.  
Select Do Not Print if you do not want the printer to print any application-generated blank  
pages that appear in your document.  
Collation  
Off*  
On  
When Collation is set to Off, the printer prints each page of a job the number of times as  
specified by the Copies setting. For example, if you send three pages to print and set Copies  
to 2, the printer prints page 1, page 1, page 2, page 2, page 3, page 3.  
When Collation is set to On, the printer prints the entire job the number of times as specified  
by the Copies setting. For example, if you send three pages to print and set Copies to 2, the  
printer prints page 1, page 2, page 3, page 1, page 2, page 3.  
Many applications collate documents by repeatedly sending the file to the printer. As a result,  
the printer must process each print job until the correct number of copies has printed. This  
requires additional time since the printer must process the same pages over again. By using  
Collation, the printer processes the file only once, saves the file in printer memory, and prints  
the multiple copies. This saves processing time for the printer and for the application, and  
overall printing time may be reduced.  
For Collation to work effectively, your software application must recognize this printer feature  
and not send the job to the printer multiple times. Your application must also let you specify  
the number of copies needed or let you use the printer default setting for Copies.  
Select Collation from the operator panel or from the printer driver. For best results, select  
Collated in the printer driver and set the number of copies to one. In your application, select  
Uncollated (if the option is available) and then select the number of copies you want.  
If the job is complex or exceeds the memory capacity of your printer, you may receive a  
37 Insufficient Collation Area message. Press Go to clear the message. The printer collates  
the remaining pages in memory. If you reset the printer, the printer discards the job. See  
37 Insufficient Collation Area on page 160 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Finishing Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Separator Sheets  
None*  
Between Copies  
Between Jobs  
Between Pages  
You can have the printer insert blank separator sheets between jobs, between multiple copies  
of a job, or between each page of a job. Separator sheets are pulled from the source specified  
in the Separator Source menu item.  
Select Between Copies for multiple copy jobs. If Collation is set to Off, a blank page is  
inserted between sets of each printed page. If Collation is set to On, a blank page is inserted  
between each copy of the job.  
Select Between Jobs to insert a blank page after each print job. This may be helpful when  
several people are using the printer.  
Select Between Pages to insert a blank page between each page of a job. This is useful if you  
are printing transparencies and want to reduce static build-up when stacking transparencies  
in the output bin.  
Separator Source  
Tray 1*  
Tray 2  
MP Feeder  
If you are using separator sheets, Separator Source lets you specify the paper source that  
holds the separator sheets.  
Only installed paper sources display as values. You can only select MP Feeder as the  
separator source if Configure MP is set to Cassette. If Separator Source is set to MP Feeder  
and Configure MP is set to First, the Separator Source setting automatically changes to  
Tray 1. See Configure MPon page 49 for more information.  
Multipage Print  
Off*  
2-Up  
3-Up  
4-Up  
6-Up  
9-Up  
12-Up  
16-Up  
Use the Multipage Print (N-up) setting to print multiple page images on a single page. For  
example, 2-Up means two page images are printed on one page, 3-Up means three page  
images are printed on one page, and so forth.  
The printer uses the Multipage Order, Multipage View, and Multipage Border settings to  
determine the order and orientation of the page images and if a border is printed around each  
page image.  
Printer setting changes within a print job may affect the results you get when using  
Multipage Print.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Finishing Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Multipage Order  
Horizontal*  
Vertical  
Rev Horizontal  
Rev Vertical  
The Multipage Order setting determines the positioning of multiple page images on pages  
printed using Multipage Print. You may choose one of four different orders. The positioning of  
page images depends on if the pages are sent to the printer as portrait or landscape images.  
The following examples show the result of using each Multipage Order setting on a 4-Up print  
job.  
Horizontal  
Portrait Landscape  
Vertical  
Landscape  
Portrait  
Page 1  
Page 1  
Page 2  
Page 3  
Page 3 Page 4  
Page 2 Page 4  
Rev Horizontal  
Portrait Landscape  
Rev Vertical  
Portrait Landscape  
Page 2  
Page 1  
Page 3  
Page 1  
Page 4 Page 3  
Page 4 Page 2  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Finishing Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Multipage View  
Auto*  
Long Edge  
Short Edge  
Use the Multipage View setting to select the orientation of the printed page with respect to the  
page images during Multipage Print.  
Select Auto to allow the printer to choose between portrait and landscape positioning.  
Select Long Edge to position the long edge of the print material as the top of the page.  
Select Short Edge to position the short edge of the print material as the top of the page.  
Note: For PostScript 3 emulation print jobs, the Auto setting is always in portrait orientation.  
Multipage Border  
None*  
Solid  
Use the Multipage Border setting to specify if a border is printed around each page image  
during Multipage Print.  
Select None if you do not want to print a border around each page image.  
Select Solid to print a solid line border around each page image.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Utilities Menu  
Use the UTILITIES MENU to print a variety of listings  
relating to available printer resources, printer settings, and  
print jobs. Additional menu items let you set up printer  
hardware and troubleshoot printer problems.  
Utilities Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Print Menus  
Press Select to print the menu settings page.  
The menu settings page is a list of the user default settings, the installed options, and the  
amount of available printer memory. This list also shows you the order of menu items.  
Note: The menu settings page must be printed on letter-, legal-, or A4-size paper.  
Print Net1 Setup  
Print Fonts  
Press Select to print the internal print server settings page.  
The internal print server settings page contains information on your network setup and the  
printer settings for your network as defined by the Network 1 Setup menu item in the  
NETWORK MENU. See Network 1 Setupon page 92 for more information.  
Note: Print Net1 Setup displays only if an internal print server is installed in your printer.  
PCL Fonts  
PS Fonts  
Press Select to print a font sample list that shows all the fonts currently available in the  
selected printer language, PCL Fonts or PS Fonts. For more information, see Printing a Font  
Print Directory  
Press Select to print a list of all the resources stored in flash memory or on the hard disk  
option.  
The Print Directory menu item is available only if at least one of the options is installed and  
formatted. Refer to the Technical Reference for details.  
Factory Defaults  
Restore  
Do Not Restore  
If you choose Restore:  
All downloaded resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) in printer memory (RAM) are  
deleted. (Resources residing in flash memory or on the hard disk option are unaffected.)  
All menu settings are returned to the factory default values except:  
Display Language (SETUP MENU) which is the operator panel display language.  
All settings in the PARALLEL MENU, SERIAL MENU, NETWORK MENU, INFRARED  
MENU, LOCALTALK MENU, USB MENU, and FAX MENU.  
The message Restoring Factory Defaults briefly appears while the printer restores the factory  
default settings. See Restoring Factory Defaults on page 157 for more information.  
Operator Panel Menus  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                             
Utilities Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Format Flash  
Yes  
No  
Formatting the flash memory option deletes all resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) stored  
in flash memory and prepares the flash memory card to receive new resources.  
The Format Flash menu item only displays if the installed flash memory option is not defective  
or Read/Write or Write protected. 51 Defective Flash may display when the printer is turned  
on, or during flash format and write operations. See 51 Defective Flash on page 161 for more  
information.  
Warning: If you select Format Flash and press Go, any data stored in flash memory is lost.  
Do not turn off the printer while the flash is formatting.  
Defragment Flash  
Yes  
No  
Defragmenting the flash memory option transfers all undeleted resources stored in flash  
memory to printer memory and then reformats the flash memory option. When the format  
operation is complete, the undeleted resources are loaded back into flash memory.  
The Defragment Flash menu item only displays if the installed flash memory option is not  
defective or Read/Write or Write protected. 51 Defective Flash may display when the printer is  
turned on, or during flash format and write operations. See 51 Defective Flash on page 161  
for more information.  
37 Insufficient Defrag Memory displays if printer memory is too full to perform the Flash  
Memory Defragment operation. See 37 Insufficient Defrag Memory on page 160 for more  
information.  
Warning: Do not turn off the printer while the flash is defragmenting.  
Format Disk  
Yes  
No  
Formatting the hard disk option deletes all resources stored on the hard disk and prepares it  
to receive new resources.  
The Format Disk menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is not defective or  
Read/Write or Write protected. 61 Defective Disk may display when the printer is turned on, or  
during disk format and write operations. See 61 Defective Disk on page 165 for more infor-  
mation.  
Format Disk does not display if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer Size on  
page 77 for more information.  
Warning: If you select Format Disk and press Go, any data stored on the hard disk option is  
lost. Do not turn off the printer while the hard disk is formatting.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Utilities Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Job Acct Stat  
Print  
Clear  
The Job Acct Stat menu item only displays if a hard disk option is installed in your printer and  
is not defective or Read/Write or Write protected. Job Accounting in the SETUP MENU must  
be set to On.  
Select Print to print a list of statistics for a defined number of the most recent print jobs. (The  
number of jobs is determined by the value of the Job Acct Limit menu item in the  
SETUP MENU). The statistics include if the job printed with or without errors, the time required  
to print the job, the size (in bytes) of the job, the requested paper size and paper type, the total  
number of printed pages, and the number of copies requested.  
Select Clear to delete all accumulated job statistics from the hard disk option. Clearing Job  
Accounting Stat displays until the process completes. See Clearing Job Accounting Stat on  
page 152 for more information.  
Hex Trace  
Press Select to enter Hex Trace mode.  
Hex Trace helps isolate the source of a print job problem. With Hex Trace selected, all data  
sent to the printer is printed in hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes are  
not run.  
To exit Hex Trace, turn the printer power Off (O), or reset the printer. To reset the printer, press  
Menu> or <Menu. JOB MENU displays. Press Menu> or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on  
the second line of the operator panel display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all Print and  
Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Job Menu  
Some JOB MENU menu items are available when the  
printer displays the Ready message and is idle since it is  
not accepting, formatting, or printing a job. Other menu  
items in JOB MENU are only available when the printer is  
busy processing or printing a job, when a printer message  
other than Ready displays, or when the printer is in Hex  
Trace mode.  
Note: For documentation pur-  
poses, Print and Hold jobs refers  
to any of the following jobs: Con-  
fidential Job, Reserve Print Job,  
Repeat Print Job, and Verify  
Print Job. See page 108 for  
more information on Print and  
Hold jobs.  
Operator Panel Menus  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Job Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Cancel Job  
Press Select to cancel the current print job.  
Cancel Job displays only when the printer is processing a print job.  
CONFIDENTIAL  
JOB  
Enter PIN  
Once a correct Personal Identification Number (PIN) is entered, the following values are  
This menu item is  
available as second and third sub-menus. See Entering a Personal Identification Number  
not displayed in the (PIN)on page 111 for more information.  
JOB MENU until the  
printer has  
processed at least  
one Confidential  
Job.  
Print All Jobs  
PRINT A JOB  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>  
...  
Note: Use your  
software application  
or printer driver to  
create and send a  
Confidential Job.  
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>  
Delete All Jobs  
DELETE A JOB  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>  
...  
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>  
PRINT COPIES  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>  
...  
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>  
Note: In the sub-menu values listed above, the Username field is based on the username  
field in your driver. By default, this is the user name or user ID you type to log on to your  
operating system. You can change the name in this field to another name in the driver before  
you send the job. The Jobname field contains a title name for your file as defined by your  
application software when the job was sent. You cannot change this field. If one or both of the  
fields is empty, the name was not defined by the application. For example, if your last name is  
Smith and your file is called timesheet, the operator panel may display smith timesheet. The  
Username and Jobname fields are truncated to 16 characters.  
When you create a Confidential Job, the printer formats your job and holds the job in memory.  
The printer delays the printing of your job until you enter a PIN assigned to the job. You enter  
the number through the operator panel. See Entering a Personal Identification Number (PIN)”  
on page 111 for more information.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
CONFIDENTIAL  
JOB  
Once a valid PIN is entered, the operator panel displays:  
(continued)  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
Print All Jobs  
You have several print or delete options to choose from:  
print all jobs  
print a job  
print copies  
delete all jobs  
delete a job  
Press Menu> or <Menu until the menu item you need appears on the second line of the  
display.  
Press Select.  
While in the values for this menu item, the following button actions are possible:  
Press Go to exit the selection and the menu group, and return to the previous screen.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to choose the next or previous option in the list.  
Press Return to exit the operation, but remain in the JOB MENU or to return to the previous  
screen after scrolling through a list of print jobs.  
Note: While in the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item, you can make selections in both PRINT A  
JOB and DELETE A JOB values. Then, both actions occur when you press Go to exit the JOB  
MENU.  
Operator Panel Menus  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
CONFIDENTIAL  
JOB  
(continued)  
Print All Jobs  
If you press Select to choose this value, printing starts and the operator panel exits this  
operation.  
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are printed.  
The message Queuing Jobs displays. For more information, see Queuing Jobson  
PRINT A JOB  
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs available for printing is displayed. The  
first job is displayed on the second line.  
PRINT A JOB  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to  
scroll through the list of available jobs.  
PRINT A JOB  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
See the note on page 60 for an explanation of Username and Jobname.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the job you want to print. When the job is on the second  
line of the display, press Select to mark the job for printing. An asterisk (*) appears to mark the  
job for printing. You may select additional jobs to print by marking them with an asterisk.  
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.  
The asterisk beside the print job is removed.  
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available print  
jobs in the DELETE A JOB list. See DELETE A JOB on page 63 for more information.  
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing  
Jobs displays; however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously  
selected some print jobs for deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an  
online state, the job starts printing. For more information, see Queuing Jobs and Queuing and  
Deleting Jobs on page 156.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
CONFIDENTIAL  
JOB  
(continued)  
Delete All Jobs  
If you press Select to choose this value, the message Delete All Jobs. Go/Stop? displays. You  
have one chance to stop the deletion of all the confidential jobs associated with your PIN.  
Note: All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are deleted.  
Press Stop if you do not want to delete all jobs. The operator panel returns to the following  
screen, and you may choose to exit the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or scroll to another  
value using Menu> or <Menu.  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
Delete All Jobs  
Press Go to delete all jobs. The message Deleting Jobs displays. The jobs are deleted and  
the printer exits the menus.  
DELETE A JOB  
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as  
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.  
DELETE A JOB  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to  
scroll through the list of available jobs.  
DELETE A JOB  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
See the note on page 60 for an explanation of Username and Jobname.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the job you want to delete. When the job is on the second  
line of the display, press Select to mark a job for deletion. An asterisk (*) appears to mark the  
job for deletion. You may select additional jobs to delete by marking them with an asterisk.  
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.  
The asterisk beside the print job is removed.  
When a job has been marked for deletion, the job is removed from the list of available print  
jobs in the PRINT A JOB list and the PRINT COPIES list. See PRINT A JOB on page 62 and  
PRINT COPIES on page 64 for more information.  
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. Once the printer exits the  
menus and returns to an online state, the jobs you selected are deleted. The message  
Deleting Jobs displays; however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you  
previously selected some jobs to print. For more information, see Deleting Jobs and Queuing  
and Deleting Jobs on page 153.  
Operator Panel Menus  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
CONFIDENTIAL  
JOB  
(continued)  
PRINT COPIES  
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as  
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.  
PRINT COPIES  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
All Confidential Jobs associated with your assigned PIN are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to  
scroll through the list of available jobs.  
PRINT COPIES  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
See the note on page 60 for an explanation of Username and Jobname.  
You may select one or more jobs to print and you may change the number of copies for each  
job to be printed.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the one job you want to print. When the job is on the  
second line of the display, press Select.  
The following prompt displays:  
Copies  
=x*  
The setting for the current number of copies is indicated by the asterisk (*). Press Menu> or  
<Menu to increase or decrease the number of copies as specified by the x value. You may  
choose to print from 1 to 999 copies of a single job at a time.  
Press Select to save the setting for the number of copies you need. The Saved message  
displays and then the list of jobs displays. An asterisk (*) appears beside the job name to  
indicate it is selected for printing. You may select other jobs to print and change the number of  
copies required.  
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available print  
jobs in the DELETE A JOB list. See DELETE A JOB on page 63 for more information.  
When you finish making selections and change the number of copies, press Return until you  
exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing Jobs displays; however,  
the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously selected some jobs for  
deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online state, the remaining copies  
print. Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from printer memory. For more infor-  
mation, see Queuing Jobs and Queuing and Deleting Jobs on page 156.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
HELD JOBS  
Print All Jobs  
PRINT A JOB  
This menu item is  
not displayed in the  
JOB MENU until the  
printer has  
processed at least  
one Repeat Print,  
Reserve Print, or  
Verify Print job.  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>  
...  
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>  
Delete All Jobs  
DELETE A JOB  
Note: Use your  
software application  
or printer driver to  
create and send a  
Repeat Print,  
Reserve Print, or  
Verify Print job.  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>  
...  
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>  
PRINT COPIES  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
<Job #3 Username> <Job #3 Jobname>  
...  
<Job #n Username> <Job #n Jobname>  
Note: In the sub-menu values listed above, the Username field is based on the username  
field in your driver. By default, this is the user name or user ID you type in to log on to your  
operating system. You can change the name in this field to another name in the driver before  
you send the job. The Jobname field contains a title name for your file as defined by your  
application software when the job was sent. You cannot change this field. If one or both of the  
fields is empty, the name was not defined by the application. For example, if your last name is  
Smith and your file is called timesheet, the operator panel may display smith timesheet. The  
Username and Jobname fields are truncated to 16 characters.  
Unlike a Confidential Job, you do not enter a PIN to access the values once you enter the  
HELD JOBS menu item.  
When you create a Repeat Print job, the job formats and prints, but the printer stores the job  
in memory so you can print additional copies of the job at a later time. As long as the job  
remains stored in memory, you may print additional copies. Repeat Jobs are automatically  
deleted when the printer requires extra memory to process additional jobs or when the  
number of Repeat Jobs stored exceeds the value of the set limit for Print and Hold Repeat  
Job Limit. For more information about this setting, refer to the Technical Reference.  
When you create a Reserve Print job, the job formats, but does not print. The printer stores  
the job in memory so you can print the job at a later time. All pages in the job are held in  
memory until you activate printing by using the operator panel to select Print All Jobs or  
PRINT A JOB. Reserve Print jobs are not deleted from memory when the job prints. To delete  
a Reserve Print job, you must request DELETE A JOB using the operator panel.  
Operator Panel Menus  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
HELD JOBS  
(continued)  
When you create a Verify Print job, the job formats, and one copy of the job prints. Additional  
requested copies are held in printer memory. You specify the number of copies you want  
when you send the job from the printer driver. This allows you to examine the first copy to be  
sure it is satisfactory before you print the other copies.  
If the job is unsatisfactory, you would not want the other copies to print. Select the  
DELETE A JOB value, and select the job to delete it. See DELETE A JOB on page 68 for more  
information.  
To print the remaining copies, you can:  
Change the number of remaining copies to print. Select PRINT COPIES. Select the specific  
job. At the Copies prompt, change the number of copies to print from the number set in the  
printer driver and press Select. Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit  
the menus. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online state, the remaining  
copies print. Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from printer memory. For more  
information, see PRINT COPIES on page 69.  
Print the number of copies set in the printer driver. Select PRINT A JOB. Select the specific  
job. The remaining copies print. Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from printer  
memory. For more information, see PRINT A JOB on page 67.  
Once you select HELD JOBS, the operator panel displays:  
HELD JOBS  
Print All Jobs  
You have several print or delete options to choose from:  
print all jobs  
print a job  
print copies  
delete all jobs  
delete a job  
Press Menu> or <Menu until the menu item you need appears on the second line of the  
display.  
Press Select.  
While in the values for this menu item, the following button actions are possible:  
Press Go to exit the selection, the menu group, and return to the previous screen.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to choose the next or previous option in the list.  
Press Return to exit the operation, but remain in the JOB MENU or to return to the previous  
screen after scrolling through a list of print jobs.  
Note: While in the HELD JOBS menu item, you can make selections in both  
PRINT A JOB and DELETE A JOB values. Then, both actions occur when you press Go to exit  
the JOB MENU.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Print All Jobs  
HELD JOBS  
(continued)  
If you press Select to choose this value, printing starts and the operator panel exits this  
operation.  
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are printed.  
The message Queuing Jobs displays. For more information, see Queuing Jobson  
PRINT A JOB  
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs available for printing is displayed. The  
first job is displayed on the second line.  
PRINT A JOB  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to scroll  
through the list of available jobs.  
PRINT A JOB  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
See the note on page 65 for an explanation of Username and Jobname.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the one job you want to print. When the job is on the  
second line of the display, press Select to mark a job for printing. An asterisk (*) appears to  
mark the job for printing. You may select additional jobs to print by marking them with an  
asterisk.  
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.  
The asterisk beside the print job is removed.  
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available print  
jobs in the DELETE A JOB list. See DELETE A JOB on page 68 for more information.  
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing  
Jobs displays; however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously  
selected some jobs for deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online  
state, the jobs you selected start printing. For more information, see Queuing Jobs and  
Queuing and Deleting Jobs on page 156.  
Operator Panel Menus  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
HELD JOBS  
(continued)  
Delete All Jobs  
If you press Select to choose this value, the message Delete All Jobs. Go/Stop? displays so  
you have one chance to stop the deletion of all the print jobs you have sent.  
Note: All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs will be deleted.  
Press Stop if you do not want to delete all jobs. The operator panel returns to the following  
screen, and you may choose to exit the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or scroll to another  
value using Menu> or <Menu.  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
Delete All Jobs  
Press Go to delete all jobs. The message Deleting Jobs displays. The jobs are deleted and  
the printer exits the menus.  
DELETE A JOB  
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as  
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.  
DELETE A JOB  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to scroll  
through the list of available jobs.  
DELETE A JOB  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
See the note on page 65 for an explanation of Username and Jobname.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the one job you want to delete. When the job you want to  
delete is on the second line of the display, press Select to mark a job for deletion. An asterisk  
(*) appears to mark the job for deletion. You may select additional jobs to delete by marking  
them with an asterisk.  
Note: If you make a mistake and mark the wrong job, press Select again to unmark the job.  
The asterisk beside the job is removed.  
When a job has been marked for deletion, the job is removed from the list of available jobs in  
the PRINT A JOB list and the PRINT COPIES list. See PRINT A JOB on page 67 and PRINT  
COPIES on page 69 for more information.  
Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. Once the printer exits the  
menus and returns to an online state, the job is deleted. The message Deleting Jobs displays;  
however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously selected some  
jobs to print. For more information, see Deleting Jobs and Queuing and Deleting Jobs on  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
HELD JOBS  
(continued)  
PRINT COPIES  
If you press Select to choose this value, a list of jobs held in printer memory is displayed as  
shown. The first job is displayed on the second line.  
PRINT COPIES  
<Job #1 Username> <Job #1 Jobname>  
All Repeat Print, Reserve Print, and Verify Print jobs are listed. Use Menu> or <Menu to scroll  
through the list of available jobs.  
PRINT COPIES  
<Job #2 Username> <Job #2 Jobname>  
See the note on page 65 for an explanation of Username and Jobname.  
You may select one or more jobs to print and you may change the number of copies for each  
job to be printed.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to scroll to the job you want to print. When the job is on the second  
line of the display, press Select.  
The following prompt displays:  
Copies  
=x*  
The setting for the current number of copies is indicated by the asterisk (*). Press Menu> or  
<Menu to increase or decrease the number of copies as specified by the x value. You may  
choose to print from 1 to 999 copies of a single job at a time.  
Note: You specify a certain number when you send a Verify Print Job. For more information,  
Press Select to save the setting for the number of copies you need. The Saved message  
displays and then the list of jobs displays. There is now an asterisk beside the job name to  
indicate it is selected for printing. You may select other jobs to print and change the number of  
copies required.  
When a job has been marked for printing, the job is removed from the list of available jobs in  
the DELETE A JOB list. See DELETE A JOB on page 68 for more information.  
When you are finished making selections and changing the number of copies, press Return  
until you exit the menus or press Go to exit the menus. The message Queuing Jobs displays;  
however, the message Queuing and Deleting Jobs displays if you previously selected some  
jobs for deletion. Once the printer exits the menus and returns to an online state, the  
remaining copies print. For more information, see Queuing Jobs and Queuing and Deleting  
Operator Panel Menus  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Job Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Reset Printer  
Press Select to reset the printer.  
Note: Before selecting Reset Printer, exit the software application you are using.  
When you select Reset Printer, the printer resets to the user default setting for each menu  
item. All downloaded resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) in printer memory (RAM) are  
deleted. All data on the currently selected host interface is deleted from the interface link  
buffer. All Print and Hold jobs are deleted.  
Print Buffer  
Press Select to print any data stored in the print buffer.  
This menu item is only available when you enter the JOB MENU while the Waiting message is  
displayed. The Waiting state occurs if an incomplete job is sent to the printer or if an ASCII job  
is being printed. Examples include sending a print screen command from your host computer  
or copying a DOS file.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Quality Menu  
Use the QUALITY MENU to change settings affecting the  
quality of the printed characters and images.  
Quality Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Print Resolution  
300 dpi  
600 dpi*  
1200 Image Q  
The Print Resolution setting defines the number of dots printed per inch (dpi). The higher the  
setting, the sharper the clarity of printed characters and graphics.  
If your print jobs are mostly text, select 600 dpi for the highest quality output. Select  
1200 Image Q (1200 Image Quality) when your job contains bitmapped images, such as  
scanned photos or some business graphics, that will benefit from enhanced line screening.  
Toner Darkness  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8*  
9
10  
Use the Toner Darkness menu item to lighten or darken the image appearance in your print  
jobs and get the most from your toner supply.  
If you want finer line width, higher definition in graphics, and lighter gray-scale images, set  
Toner Darkness to 6 or 7.  
If you want a bolder line width, emphasis in graphics, or darker gray-scale images, set  
Toner Darkness to 9 or 10. Use the 10 value to emphasize line width, produce the boldest text,  
and the darkest images.  
If you want to help conserve the printer toner supply, use the 1 to 5 values.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Quality Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Toner Darkness  
(continued)  
When you first enter Toner Darkness, the operator panel displays:  
Toner Darkness  
=8 -.......v..+*  
Notice the periods (.) displayed across the second line of the operator panel. Each period  
represents one of the numbers 1 through 10 from left to right. A symbol like a v or an arrow  
points to the location of the 8 value, which is the factory default.  
A minus sign (-) at the left end of the string of periods indicates you are scrolling to the lower  
numbers in the string. A plus sign (+) at the right end of the string of periods indicates you are  
scrolling to the higher numbers in the string. If you decide to change the setting to 6, for  
example, use <Menu to scroll back to the 6.  
Toner Darkness  
=6 -.....v.|..+  
As you scroll backward toward the minus sign (-) indicating lower numbers, notice the v or  
arrow symbol moves on the operator panel as you press the <Menu button. It now appears in  
place of the sixth period. Notice the numeral 6 displays next to the equal sign to indicate your  
selection. A vertical bar (|) indicates the factory default of 8. The vertical bar remains at 8  
unless 8 is selected. Then, the arrow covers the vertical bar.  
Press Select to select 6 as your current setting. The Saved message displays.  
PQET  
Off  
On*  
When printed characters appear to have jagged or uneven edges, set PQET (Print Quality  
Enhancement Technology) to On to improve the print quality of your text and make the  
characters appear smoother.  
PictureGrade  
Off  
On*  
Use the PictureGrademenu item to improve the quality of gray-scale printing at 300 and  
600 dpi resolutions in PostScript 3 emulation.  
If you select Off, the printer uses the standard screening parameters. If you select On,  
different default screening parameters are used to improve the print quality of graphics.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup Menu  
Use the SETUP MENU to configure a variety of printer  
features.  
Setup Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Printer Language  
PCL Emulation*  
PS Emulation  
The printer language defines how the computer communicates with the printer. Your computer  
uses printer languages, such as PCL emulation and PostScript 3 emulation, to send print data  
to the printer. Setting a printer language as the default does not prevent the software appli-  
cation from sending print jobs that use the other printer language.  
Power Saver  
Disabled  
1120 (20*) [Optra M410]  
1240 (15*) [Optra M412]  
The Power Saver menu item lets you reduce power usage when the printer is idle by deter-  
mining the length of time (in minutes) the printer waits after a job is printed before it goes to a  
reduced power state.  
If you have selected a Power Saver value, the Power Saver message replaces the Ready  
message and becomes the new printer default when the printer is in a Ready state. Both  
messages indicate the printer is ready to receive jobs.  
If your printer is in constant use, select a high setting, such as 120. Under most circum-  
stances, this keeps the printer ready to print with minimum warm-up time. However, a high  
setting also uses more energy.  
Set Power Saver to 1 to put the printer in Power Saver mode one minute after it finishes a print  
job. This uses much less energy, but requires more warm-up time for the printer. If your printer  
shares an electrical circuit with room lighting and you notice lights flickering, you may want to  
set Power Saver to 1.  
If you want a balance between energy consumption and a shorter warm-up period, select a  
Power Saver value between 1 and 120 minutes or 1 and 240 minutes depending on your  
printer model.  
Note: Some printer models released in the year 2000 or later designated as Energy Star  
printers cannot have Power Saver disabled.  
Resource Save  
Off*  
On  
The Resource Save setting determines what the printer does with downloaded resources,  
such as fonts and macros, if it receives a job that requires more memory than is available.  
If Resource Save is set to On, the printer retains all permanent downloaded resources for all  
printer languages during language changes and printer resets. If the printer runs out of  
memory, Memory Full appears on the operator panel display.  
If Resource Save is set to Off, the printer retains permanent downloaded resources only until  
memory is needed. Then it deletes those resources stored for the inactive printer language.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Setup Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Download Target  
RAM*  
Flash  
Disk  
The Download Target menu item specifies the storage location for downloaded resources,  
such as fonts and macros.  
Storing downloaded resources in flash memory or hard disk is permanent storage rather than  
the temporary storage that RAM provides. You can add resources to flash memory or to the  
hard disk until the option is full. Use your software application or the printer Toolkit to  
download resources to the printer.  
The Download Target menu item only displays if a formatted flash memory option or hard disk  
option is installed in the printer and is not defective or Read/Write or Write protected.  
51 Defective Flash or 61 Defective Disk may display when the printer is turned on, or during  
format and write operations. See 51 Defective Flash on page 161 or 61 Defective Disk on  
page 165 for more information.  
Disk does not display for Download Target if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer  
Size on page 77 for more information.  
If neither option is installed, Download Target does not display and all downloaded resources  
are automatically stored in printer memory (RAM).  
Print Timeout  
Disabled  
1255 (90*)  
The Print Timeout setting determines the time (in seconds) the printer waits before printing  
the last page of a print job that does not end with a command to print the page. The print  
timeout counter does not start until the Waiting message displays.  
When a print timeout occurs, the printer stores the page in the print buffer.  
Select Disabled to turn Print Timeout off. When Print Timeout is disabled, the printer does not  
print the last page of a print job until one of the following occurs:  
The printer receives enough information to fill the page.  
The printer receives a Form Feed command.  
You select Print Buffer from the JOB MENU. See page 70 for more information.  
Wait Timeout  
Disabled  
1565535 (40*)  
The Wait Timeout setting determines the amount of time (in seconds) the printer waits to  
receive additional bytes of data from the computer. When this timeout expires, the print job is  
canceled.  
Select Disabled to turn Wait Timeout off.  
Wait Timeout is only available when using PostScript 3 emulation. The setting has no effect  
on PCL emulation print jobs.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Auto Continue  
Disabled*  
5255  
Set Auto Continue to a value between 5 seconds and 255 seconds to have the printer  
continue printing after it detects one of the following errors:  
34 Short Paper  
35 Res Save Off Deficient Memory  
37 Insufficient Collation Area  
37 Insufficient Defrag Memory  
37 Insufficient Memory  
38 Memory Full  
39 Complex Page  
51 Defective Flash  
52 Flash Full  
53 Unformatted Flash  
54 Serial Option 1 Error  
54 Std Par ENA Connection Lost  
54 Par 1 ENA Connection Lost  
54 Ser 1 Fax Connection Lost  
54 Network 1 Software Error  
55 Insufficient Fax Buffer  
56 Serial Port 1 Disabled  
56 Std Parallel Port Disabled  
56 Parallel Port 1 Disabled  
58 Too Many Flash Options  
61 Defective Disk  
62 Disk Full  
63 Unformatted Disk  
Print Jobs on Disk? Go/Stop?  
If one of these errors occurs and Auto Continue is set to Disabled, the printer stops and waits  
for operator intervention. When Auto Continue is set to a numerical value, the printer waits for  
the specified length of time and then automatically resumes processing.  
This setting is also used as a timer. After an inactive period in the menus, the printer automat-  
ically exits the menus and returns to the Ready state.  
Jam Recovery  
On  
Off  
Auto*  
When Jam Recovery is set to Off, the printer does not reprint a page that has jammed.  
When Jam Recovery is set to On, the printer keeps the image for a printed page until the  
printer signals that the page has successfully exited the printer. The printer reprints all  
jammed pages.  
If Jam Recovery is set to Auto, the printer keeps the image and reprints the page unless the  
memory required to hold the page is needed for other printer tasks.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Setup Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Page Protect  
Off*  
On  
Set Page Protect to On to make sure an entire page is processed before it is printed. This may  
be helpful if you are having trouble printing a page properly because of complex page errors.  
If you still cannot print the page, your printer may not have enough memory to process the  
page. You may have to reduce the size and number of fonts on the page, or increase the  
installed printer memory.  
For most print jobs, you do not need to set Page Protect to On. When Page Protect is set to  
On, printing may be slowed.  
Print Area  
Normal*  
Whole Page  
The Print Area setting lets you modify the PCL formatting area and the printer physical print  
area. Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about printable areas.  
Display Language  
English*  
French  
German  
Italian  
Spanish  
Danish  
Norwegian  
Dutch  
Swedish  
Portuguese  
Finnish  
The following languages appear as a menu item value on some operator panels:  
Japanese  
Russian  
Polish  
Hungarian  
Turkish  
Czech  
The Display Language setting determines the language of the text that appears on the  
operator panel display.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Alarm Control  
Off  
Single*  
Continuous  
If you want the printer alarm to sound any time the printer requires intervention, select Single  
or Continuous. If you select Single, the printer sounds three quick beeps to let you know  
operator intervention is required. If you select Continuous, the printer repeats the three beeps  
every ten seconds.  
Select Off if you do not want the alarm to sound.  
Job Buffer Size  
Disabled*  
10100%  
If you have a hard disk option installed in your printer, you can allocate a portion of the  
available hard disk space for processing print jobs. The job is temporarily stored on the hard  
disk before being printed, usually freeing the host computer while the job prints.  
The Job Buffer Size menu item lets you select the amount of hard disk space allocated to job  
buffering for all ports that have Job Buffering set to On. You can choose any 1% increment  
between 10% and 100%. You must select a Job Buffer Size before you can set the  
Job Buffering menu item On in the PARALLEL MENU or USB MENU. See Job Buffering on  
page 85 and on page 101 for more information.  
The Job Buffer Size menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is formatted and  
is not defective or Read/Write or Write protected. 61 Defective Disk may display when the  
printer is turned on, or during disk format and write operations. See 61 Defective Disk on  
page 165 for more information.  
To password protect the hard disk option and use Job Buffering simultaneously, perform the  
following steps in order:  
Set the Job Buffer Size for the hard disk option.  
Download the files you want to the hard disk option.  
Password protect the disk.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for detailed information on how to password protect the hard  
disk option.  
Warning: If you change the job buffer size, the printer formats the hard disk, and all resources  
stored on the disk are deleted.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Setup Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Job Accounting  
Off*  
On  
If Job Accounting is set to On, the installed hard disk option stores statistical information  
about the most recent printer jobs. The statistics include whether the job printed with or  
without errors, the time required to print the job, the size (in bytes) of the job, the requested  
paper size and paper type, the total number of printed pages, and the number of copies  
requested.  
To print a listing of all the accumulated statistics, select Print from the Job Acct Stat menu  
item in the UTILITIES MENU. See Job Acct Stat on page 59 for more information.  
The Job Accounting menu item does not display if the installed disk option is defective or  
Read/Write or Write protected, or if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer Size on  
page 77 for more information.  
Job Acct Limit  
Disabled  
101000* (in increments of 1 job)  
If a hard disk option is installed in your printer, you can use the hard disk to store statistical  
information about a specified number of jobs. The value you select from the Job Acct Limit  
menu item determines the number of jobs for which statistics are stored. Once you reach the  
job limit, statistics for the oldest job are deleted as new statistics are stored, maintaining  
statistics for the specified number of jobs.  
If you select Disabled, the number of jobs for which statistics are stored is limited to the  
memory available on the hard disk.  
The Job Acct Limit menu item does not display if the installed hard disk option is defective or  
Read/Write or Write protected, or if Job Buffer Size is set to 100%. See Job Buffer Size on  
page 77 for more information.  
Warning: When you change the Job Acct Limit value, all statistical information stored on the  
disk option is discarded.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
PCL Emul Menu  
Use the PCL EMUL MENU to change printer settings that  
only affect jobs printed using the PCL emulation printer  
language.  
PCL Emul Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Font Source  
Resident*  
Download  
Flash  
Disk  
All  
The Font Source setting determines which fonts appear in the Font Name menu.  
If a font source is not installed or does not contain any fonts, it is not listed as a value. Fonts  
are loaded and stored on the flash memory option.  
See Understanding Fontson page 231 for more information.  
Font Name  
Font position and font name for all fonts in the selected font source (displays on both lines of  
the operator panel)  
(R0 Courier*)  
After you select a font source, choose the specific font from the Font Name menu item. The  
printer displays the font source abbreviation, font ID, and font name for each font. The font  
source abbreviation is R for resident, F for flash, K for disk, and D for download.  
Note: Always select the correct Font Source before you select the Font Name.  
To print a font sample list showing all the fonts available for PCL emulation, see Printing a  
Point Size  
11008 (in increments of 0.25)  
(only displays for  
PostScript or  
(12*)  
typographic fonts)  
Point size refers to the height of the characters in the font. One point equals approximately  
1/72 of an inch.  
If you chose a scalable typographic font, you can select the point size for the font. You can  
select point sizes from 1 to 1008 in increments of 0.25 points. See Pitch and Point Sizeon  
page 232 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
PCL Emul Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Pitch  
0.08100 (in increments of 0.01)  
(only displays for  
fixed or  
(10*)  
monospaced fonts)  
Pitch refers to the number of fixed-space characters in a horizontal inch of type.  
If you chose a scalable monospaced font, you can select the font pitch. You can select a pitch  
from 0.08 to 100 characters per inch (cpi) in increments of 0.01 cpi. For non-scalable  
monospaced fonts, the pitch displays, but it cannot be changed. See Pitch and Point Sizeon  
page 232 for more information.  
Symbol Set  
List of Symbol Set IDs and Symbol Set names (displays on both lines of the operator panel)  
10U PC-8* (Country specific)  
12U PC-850* (Country specific)  
A symbol set is a set of alphabetic and numeric characters, punctuation, and special symbols  
used when printing with a selected font. Symbol sets support the different requirements for  
languages or specific applications, such as math symbols for scientific text. The printer  
displays only the symbol sets supported for the selected font name.  
Orientation  
Portrait*  
Landscape  
The Orientation setting determines how the printing is oriented on the page.  
Select Portrait to print parallel to the short edge of the print material.  
This is  
PORTRAIT  
orientation.  
This is  
PORTRAIT  
orientation.  
This is  
Select Landscape to print parallel to the long edge of the print material.  
This is  
LANDSCAPE  
orientation. This  
is LANDSCAPE  
orientation.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
PCL Emul Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Lines per Page  
1255  
60* (Country specific)  
64* (Country specific)  
Use the Lines per Page menu item to change the number of lines that print on each page.  
The Lines per Page setting can range from 1 to 255 lines per page. The printer sets the  
amount of space between each line (vertical line spacing) based on the Lines per Page,  
PAPER SIZE, and Orientation settings. Select the correct PAPER SIZE from the PAPER MENU  
and Orientation before setting Lines per Page. See PAPER SIZE on page 45 and Orientation  
on page 80 for more information.  
A4 Width  
198 mm*  
203 mm  
The A4 Width menu item lets you select the width of the logical page for A4 paper.  
When you select 198 mm, the width of the logical page is compatible with that of the  
Hewlett-Packard LaserJet 5 printer. When you select 203 mm, the width of the logical page is  
wide enough to print eighty 10-pitch characters.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
PCL Emul Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
TRAY RENUMBER Assign MP Feeder  
Assign Tray 1  
Assign Tray 2  
Assign Man Paper  
Assign Man Env  
Each of the above menu items supports the following three values:  
Off*  
0 ... 199  
None  
VIEW FACTORY DEF  
Restore Defaults  
Yes  
No  
Note: Assign Tray 2 only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.  
Assign MP Feeder only displays when Configure MP is set to Cassette.  
Only installed paper sources display on the operator panel as values. However, you may set  
TRAY RENUMBER to uninstalled sources.  
The TRAY RENUMBER menu item lets you configure your printer to work with printer drivers  
or applications that use different source assignments to request a given input source.  
Select Off to use the factory default paper source assignments.  
Select a numeric value (0 ... 199) to assign a custom value to a paper source.  
Select VIEW FACTORY DEF to view the factory default values assigned to each paper source.  
In the Restore Defaults menu item, select Yes to return all tray assignments to factory default  
values.  
See Paper Sources and Sizeson page 116 for information on available paper sources for  
your printer.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about assigning source numbers.  
Auto CR after LF  
Auto LF after CR  
*Factory default  
Off*  
On  
The Auto CR after LF setting determines if the printer automatically performs a carriage return  
after a line feed control command.  
Off*  
On  
The Auto LF after CR setting determines if the printer automatically performs a line feed after  
a carriage return control command.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
PostScript Menu  
Use the POSTSCRIPT MENU to change settings that only  
affect jobs printed using the PostScript 3 emulation printer  
language.  
PostScript Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Print PS Error  
Off*  
On  
Select On to print PostScript 3 emulation errors. If an error occurs, the job stops processing,  
the error message prints, and the printer discards the job.  
If Print PS Error is set to Off and an error occurs, the job is discarded but no error message  
prints.  
Font Priority  
Resident*  
Flash / Disk  
The Font Priority menu item only displays if a flash memory or disk option is installed,  
formatted and is not defective, Read/Write or Write protected and Job Buffer Size is not set to  
100%. See Job Buffer Size on page 77 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Parallel Menu  
Use the PARALLEL MENU to change settings affecting  
jobs sent to the printer through the parallel interface con-  
nection. PARALLEL MENU displays as a standard feature  
or as an option, and appears as one of the following:  
STD PARALLEL  
PARALLEL OPT 1  
PARALLEL OPT 1 is only available if a parallel/ USB  
interface option card is installed. The following menu  
items set the configuration of the parallel interface connec-  
tion.  
Parallel Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the parallel interface  
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the parallel interface  
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer  
language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Parallel Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
NPA Mode  
On  
Off  
Auto*  
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network  
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA  
mode requires special processing of the print data.  
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad  
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode  
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in  
either format.  
The NPA Mode setting in the PARALLEL MENU applies only to the parallel interface  
connection.  
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.  
Parallel Buffer  
Disabled  
Auto*  
3K to maximum size allowed  
You can configure the size of the parallel input buffer to meet the requirements of your system.  
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your  
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To  
maximize the range for the parallel buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the serial,  
network, infrared, LocalTalk, and Universal Serial Bus (USB) buffers.  
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of  
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the Parallel Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
Job Buffering  
Off*  
On  
Job buffering lets you delay processing of a print job. The job is temporarily stored on a hard  
disk option before being printed, usually freeing the host computer while the job prints.  
The Job Buffering menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is formatted and is  
not defective, Read/Write or Write protected, and if Job Buffer Size is not set to Disabled. See  
Job Buffer Size on page 77 for more information. 61 Defective Disk may display when the  
printer is turned on, or during disk format and write operations. See 61 Defective Disk on  
page 165 for more information.  
If Job Buffering is set to On, print jobs are buffered to the hard disk option. If Job Buffering is  
set to Off, print jobs are not buffered.  
Note: Changing the Job Buffering setting automatically resets the printer.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Parallel Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Advanced Status  
Off  
On*  
If Advanced Status is set to On, bidirectional communication is enabled through the parallel  
interface.  
Protocol  
Standard  
Fastbytes*  
You can select Standard or Fastbytes protocol for the parallel interface. Fastbytes is  
compatible with most existing parallel interface implementations. Use Standard only if you  
experience parallel interface problems.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about the parallel interface.  
Honor Init  
Off*  
On  
The Honor Init setting determines whether the printer honors hardware initialization requests  
from the computer. The computer requests initialization by activating the INIT signal on the  
parallel interface. Many personal computers activate the INIT signal each time the computer is  
turned on and off.  
Parallel Mode 1  
Off  
On*  
The Parallel Mode 1 setting controls the pull up resistors on the parallel port signals. It is  
useful for personal computers that have open collector outputs on the parallel port signals.  
Set Parallel Mode 1 to On to disable the resistors or to Off to enable the resistors.  
Note: This menu item is not available on the Optra M412.  
Parallel Mode 2  
Off  
On*  
The Parallel Mode 2 setting determines if the parallel port data is sampled on the leading or  
trailing edge of strobe.  
If Parallel Mode 2 is set to On, the parallel port data is sampled on the leading edge of strobe.  
If Parallel Mode 2 is set to Off, the parallel port data is sampled on the trailing edge of strobe.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Serial Menu  
Use the SERIAL MENU to change settings affecting jobs  
sent to the printer through the serial interface port.  
SERIAL MENU displays as an option, and appears as  
SERIAL OPTION 1. SERIAL OPTION 1 is only available if  
the Tri-Port interface option card is installed and Fax Port  
is set to disabled.  
Serial Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the serial interface  
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the serial interface  
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer  
language.  
If both PCL Smartswitch and PS Smartswitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
NPA Mode  
On  
Off  
Auto*  
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network  
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA  
mode requires special processing of the print data.  
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad  
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode  
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in  
either format.  
The NPA Mode setting in the SERIAL MENU applies only to the serial interface connection.  
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Serial Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Serial Buffer  
Disabled  
Auto*  
3K to maximum size allowed  
You can configure the size of the serial input buffer to meet the requirements of your system.  
If the limited size of the serial buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your software  
application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the buffer size.  
The maximum size depends on the amount of memory in your printer, the size of the other link  
buffers and whether the Resource Save setting is set to On or Off. To maximize the range for  
the serial buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the parallel, infrared, LocalTalk,  
and USB buffers. Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total  
amount of available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the Serial Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
RS-232/RS-422  
RS-422 Polarity  
RS-232*  
RS-422  
Choose the serial communication configuration for your printer. Selecting RS-422 automat-  
ically sets Serial Protocol to XON/XOFF.  
Normal*  
Reverse  
Select Normal or Reverse polarity.  
This setting is only available if the serial communication configuration is set to RS-422. To do  
this, select SERIAL MENU, SERIAL OPTION 1, RS-232/RS-422, and RS-422.  
Serial Protocol  
DTR* (hardware handshaking)  
DTR/DSR (hardware handshaking)  
XON/XOFF (software handshaking)  
XON/XOFF/DTR (combined handshaking)  
XON/XOFF/DTR/DSR (combined handshaking)  
Handshaking is the exchange of predetermined signals when a connection is established.  
This printer supports hardware handshaking, software handshaking, and combined hardware  
and software handshaking.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about serial interface.  
Robust XON  
Off*  
On  
Robust XON only applies to the serial port if Serial Protocol is set to XON/XOFF.  
When Robust XON is set to On, the printer sends a continuous stream of XONs to the host  
computer to indicate that the serial port is ready to receive more data.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Serial Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Baud  
1200  
2400  
4800  
9600*  
19200  
38400  
57600  
115200  
This setting lets you select the rate at which data is being sent to or from your computer. Refer  
to the Technical Reference for information about the range of baud values.  
Data Bits  
7
8*  
This setting lets you select the number of data bits that are sent in each transmission frame.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about data bits.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Serial Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Parity  
Even  
Odd  
None*  
Ignore  
This setting lets you select the parity for serial input and output data frames.  
Even The port expects to receive data frames with an even number of logical 1s per  
byte. The port transmits XOFF and XON with even parity. If the port detects a  
parity error, the port sends an inverted question mark to the printer instead of the  
character sent by the host system.  
Odd  
The port expects to receive data frames with an odd number of logical 1s per  
byte. The printer transmits XOFF and XON with odd parity. If the printer detects a  
parity error, the port sends X'5F' to the printer instead of the character sent by the  
host system.  
None The port expects no parity bit when it receives data. The port transmits XON and  
XOFF without parity bits.  
Ignore The port expects a parity bit when the port receives a data frame. The port  
ignores the parity bit. The port uses even parity when it transmits XON and XOFF.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about parity.  
Honor DSR  
(only available if  
configured for  
RS-232)  
Off*  
On  
Honor DSR determines if the printer uses the Data Set Ready (DSR) signal. DSR is one of the  
handshaking signals for most serial interface cables. If Honor DSR is set to Off, data received  
by the serial interface is seen as valid data. If Honor DSR is set to On, only data received  
while the DSR signal is in high condition is treated as valid data.  
The serial interface uses DSR to distinguish data sent by the computer from data created by  
electrical noise in the serial cable. This electrical noise can cause stray characters to print.  
Set Honor DSR to On to prevent stray characters from printing.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Network Menu  
Use the NETWORK MENU to change settings affecting  
jobs sent to the printer through the network port.  
NETWORK MENU displays as an option, and appears as  
NETWORK OPTION 1. NETWORK OPTION 1 is only  
available if an optional print server is installed in your  
printer.  
Network Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the network interface  
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch set to On as the default.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On the printer examines the data on the network interface  
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer  
language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
NPA Mode  
Off  
Auto*  
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network  
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA  
mode requires special processing of the print data.  
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad  
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode  
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in  
either format.  
The NPA Mode setting in the NETWORK MENU applies only to the network interface  
connection.  
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Network Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Network Buffer  
Auto*  
3K to maximum size allowed  
You can configure the size of the network input buffer to meet the requirements of your  
system. If the limited size of the network buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your  
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the  
buffer size.  
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your  
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To  
maximize the range for the network buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the  
parallel and USB buffers.  
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate the buffer size proportional to the total amount of  
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the Network Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
Network 1 Setup  
*Factory default  
Values for this menu item are supplied by the specific network card. Open the menu to see the  
available values.  
For more information, refer to the documentation that comes with your network option.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Infrared Menu  
Use the INFRARED MENU to change settings affecting  
jobs sent to the printer through the infrared interface port.  
If Infrared Port is set to Disabled, all other menu items in the  
INFRARED MENU are not available.  
This menu is only available if the Tri-Port interface option  
card is installed in your printer.  
Infrared Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Infrared Port  
Disabled*  
IR Option 1  
Select IR Option 1 to activate the infrared port on the Tri-Port interface option card.  
If you select Disabled, all of the other menu items in the INFRARED MENU are not available.  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the infrared interface  
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On the printer examines the data on the network infrared  
connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer  
language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Infrared Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
NPA Mode  
Off  
Auto*  
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network  
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA  
mode requires special processing of the print data.  
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad  
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode  
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in  
either format.  
The NPA Mode setting in the INFRARED MENU applies only to the infrared interface  
connection.  
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.  
Infrared Buffer  
Disabled  
Auto*  
5K to maximum size allowed  
You can configure the size of the infrared input buffer to meet the requirements of your  
system. If the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your  
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the  
buffer size.  
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your  
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To  
maximize the range for the infrared buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the  
parallel, serial, LocalTalk, and USB buffers.  
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of  
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the Infrared Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
Window Size  
Auto*  
1
The Window Size setting specifies the maximum number of infrared frames the printer can  
receive before it must send an acknowledgment to the host computer.  
Select Auto to let the printer automatically set the window size during a power on reset to  
maximize link performance.  
In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting. If you have trouble printing using the  
infrared port, changing the Window Size setting to 1 may resolve the problem.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Infrared Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Transmit Delay  
Auto*  
None  
115  
The Transmit Delay setting defines the amount of time the printer must wait before trans-  
mitting meaningful infrared data to the host computer, as well as the amount of time the  
printer requests the host computer to wait before it transmits infrared data.  
Select Auto to let the printer automatically set the Transmit Delay value during a power on  
reset to maximize link performance.  
In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting. If you have trouble printing using the  
infrared port, selecting a high Transmit Delay setting, such as 15, may resolve the problem.  
Max Baud Rate  
2400  
9600  
19200  
38400  
57600  
115200  
576000  
1152000*  
4000000  
The maximum baud rate possible for both the printer and the infrared adapter is automatically  
set during a power on reset. However, if your printer is situated in a bright or highly reflective  
environment, you may experience intermittent communication problems. If you do, select a  
lower baud rate for the infrared connection.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
LocalTalk Menu  
Use the LOCALTALK MENU to change settings affecting  
jobs sent to the printer through the LocalTalk port.  
If LocalTalk Port is set to Disabled, all other menu items in  
the LOCALTALK MENU are not available.  
This menu is only available if the Tri-Port interface option  
card is installed in your printer.  
LocalTalk Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
LocalTalk Port  
Disabled*  
LTalk Option 1  
Select LTalk Option 1 to activate the LocalTalk port on the Tri-Port interface option card.  
If you select Disabled, all of the other menu items in the LOCALTALK MENU are not available.  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the LocalTalk interface  
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the specified LocalTalk  
interface connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the printer  
language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is set  
to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the default.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
LocalTalk Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
NPA Mode  
Off  
Auto*  
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in Network  
Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the NPA. NPA  
mode requires special processing of the print data.  
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as bad  
data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If NPA Mode  
is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then processes it in  
either format.  
The NPA Mode setting in the LOCALTALK MENU applies only to the LocalTalk interface  
connection.  
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.  
LocalTalk Buffer  
Disabled  
Auto*  
6K to maximum size allowed  
You can configure the size of the LocalTalk input buffer to meet the requirements of your  
system. If the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your  
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the  
buffer size.  
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your  
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To  
maximize the range for the LocalTalk buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the  
parallel, serial, infrared, and USB buffers.  
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of  
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the LocalTalk Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
NPA Hosts  
110 (2*)  
Use this setting to specify the maximum number of NPA hosts that can register for NPA printer  
alerts. When the number of hosts registered for NPA alerts exceeds the quantity specified by  
NPA Hosts, any additional hosts attempting to register for alerts are ignored.  
Note: Changing the NPA Hosts setting automatically resets the printer.  
LocalTalk Name  
*Factory default  
Lexmark Optra M410 or Lexmark Optra M412  
This setting identifies the printer model name stored in printer memory. It cannot be modified  
through the operator panel.  
Operator Panel Menus  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
LocalTalk Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
LocalTalk Addr  
(LocalTalk Node Number)  
This setting identifies the LocalTalk Node number assigned to the printer. It cannot be  
modified through the operator panel.  
LocalTalk Zone  
*Factory default  
(Zone name provided by LocalTalk network)  
This setting determines the LocalTalk Zone. It cannot be modified through the operator panel.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
USB Menu  
Use the USB MENU to change settings affecting the Uni-  
versal Serial Bus (USB) interface port. The USB MENU  
displays as a standard feature or as an option, and appears  
as one of the following:  
STANDARD USB  
USB OPTION 1  
USB OPTION 1 is only available if a parallel/ USB inter-  
face option card is installed on the printer system board.  
See Using a USB Cableon page 14 for information on  
how to attached a USB cable and Parallel/ USB Interface  
Option Cardon page 215 for installation information.  
USB Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PCL SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the USB interface  
connection and selects PCL emulation if the data indicates that is the printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is  
set to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the  
default.  
PS SmartSwitch  
Off  
On*  
If PS SmartSwitch is set to On, the printer examines the data on the specified USB  
interface connection and selects PostScript 3 emulation if the data indicates that is the  
printer language.  
If both PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to Off, the printer uses the language  
specified in the Printer Language menu as the default. If only one SmartSwitch setting is  
set to Off, the printer uses the language that has its SmartSwitch setting set to On as the  
default.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
USB Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
NPA Mode  
On  
Off  
Auto*  
NPA is a mode of bidirectional communication that follows the conventions defined in  
Network Printing Alliance Protocol, A Printer/Host Control Specification Developed by the  
NPA. NPA mode requires special processing of the print data.  
If NPA Mode is set to On, the data received must be in NPA format. If not, it is rejected as  
bad data. If NPA Mode is set to Off, the printer does not perform any NPA processing. If  
NPA Mode is set to Auto, the printer examines the data to determine the format and then  
processes it in either format.  
The NPA Mode setting in the USB MENU applies only to the USB interface connection.  
Note: Changing the NPA Mode setting automatically resets the printer.  
USB Buffer  
Disabled  
Auto*  
3K to maximum size allowed  
You can configure the size of the USB input buffer to meet the requirements of your  
system. If the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from continuing work in your  
software application each time you send a job to the printer, you may want to increase the  
buffer size.  
The maximum size available for modification depends on the amount of memory in your  
printer, the size of the other link buffers, and whether Resource Save is set to On or Off. To  
maximize the range for the USB buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the  
parallel, serial, network, infrared, and LocalTalk buffers.  
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of  
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the USB Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
USB Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Job Buffering  
Off*  
On  
This menu item only displays if you are using standard USB and have a hard disk option  
card installed.  
Job buffering lets you delay processing of a print job. The job is temporarily stored on a  
hard disk option before being printed, usually freeing the host computer while the job  
prints.  
The Job Buffering menu item only displays if the installed hard disk option is formatted and  
is not defective, Read/Write or Write protected, and if Job Buffer Size is not set to  
Disabled. See Job Buffer Size on page 77 for more information. 61 Defective Disk may  
display when the printer is turned on, or during disk format and write operations. See  
61 Defective Disk on page 165 for more information.  
If Job Buffering is set to On, print jobs are buffered to the hard disk option. If Job Buffering  
is set to Off, print jobs are not buffered.  
Note: Changing the Job Buffering setting automatically resets the printer.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Fax Menu  
Use the FAX MENU to change settings affecting fax data  
received by the printer through the serial interface port on  
the Tri-Port interface option card.  
With the Tri-Port interface option card installed, the  
printer can receive and print fax data.  
If Fax Port is set to Disabled, all other menu items in the  
FAX MENU are not available.  
Ser Option 1 is only available if a Tri-Port interface option  
card is installed in your printer. See Tri-Port Interface  
information.  
Fax Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Fax Port  
Disabled*  
Ser Option 1  
Select Ser Option 1 to activate the serial port on the Tri-Port interface option card and  
configure it to receive fax data.  
If you select Disabled, all of the other menu items in the FAX MENU are not available.  
Fax Baud  
1200  
2400  
4800  
9600  
19200*  
38400  
57600  
115200  
This setting lets you select the rate at which fax data is being sent to or from your computer.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for information about the range of baud values.  
Fax Data Bits  
7
8*  
This setting lets you select the number of fax data bits that are sent in each transmission  
frame. Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about data bits.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Fax Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Fax Parity  
Even  
Odd  
None*  
Ignore  
The Fax Parity setting lets you select the parity for fax data frames.  
Even The port expects to receive data frames with an even number of logical 1s per  
byte. The port transmits XOFF and XON with even parity. If the port detects a  
parity error, it sends an inverted question mark to the printer instead of the  
character sent by the host system.  
Odd  
The port expects to receive data frames with an odd number of logical 1s per byte.  
The printer transmits XOFF and XON with odd parity. If the printer detects a parity  
error, it sends X'5F' to the printer instead of the character sent by the host system.  
None The port expects no parity bit when it receives data. The port transmits XON and  
XOFF without parity bits.  
Ignore The port expects a parity bit when it receives a data frame. The port ignores the  
parity bit and uses even parity when it transmits XON and XOFF.  
Refer to the Technical Reference for more information about parity.  
Fax Buffer  
Disabled  
Auto*  
105K to max size allowed  
You can configure the size of the fax input buffer to meet the requirements of your system. If  
the limited size of the input buffer is preventing you from receiving fax data, you may want to  
increase the fax buffer size.  
The maximum size depends on the amount of memory in your printer, the size of the other link  
buffers and whether the Resource Save setting is set to On or Off. To maximize the range for  
the fax buffer size, you can disable or reduce the size of the parallel, infrared, LocalTalk, and  
USB buffers.  
Choose Auto to let the printer calculate a buffer size proportional to the total amount of  
available printer memory. In most cases, Auto is the recommended setting.  
Note: Changing the Fax Buffer setting automatically resets the printer.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Fax Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Fax Paper Size  
A4* (Country specific)  
A5  
JIS B5  
Letter* (Country specific)  
Legal  
Executive  
Universal  
The Fax Paper Size setting lets you specify the size of print material used for printing fax data.  
Incoming faxes are automatically formatted to print on the paper size set in the Fax Paper Size  
menu item.  
The printer automatically prints from the paper source containing the correct paper size and  
paper type as specified in the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. If no paper source  
contains the correct paper size and paper type, you are prompted to change the print material  
in a selected source to match the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. See Fax Paper  
Type on page 105 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Fax Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Fax Paper Type  
Plain Paper*  
Card Stock  
Transparency  
Labels  
Bond  
Letterhead  
Preprinted  
Colored Paper  
Custom Type 1  
Custom Type 2  
Custom Type 3  
Custom Type 4  
Custom Type 5  
Custom Type 6  
The Fax Paper Type setting lets you specify the type of print material used for printing fax data.  
The printer automatically prints from the paper source containing the correct paper size and  
paper type as specified in the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. If no paper source  
contains the correct paper size and paper type, you are prompted to change the print material  
in a selected source to match the Fax Paper Size and Fax Paper Type settings. See Fax Paper  
Size on page 104 for more information.  
Custom Type 1 through 6 refers to special types of print materials. You can change the names  
through a utility, such as MarkVision. The user-defined name is truncated to 14 characters. For  
more information on setting the Custom Type names, see CUSTOM TYPES on page 49.  
*Factory default  
Operator Panel Menus  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Config Menu  
You only have access to the CONFIG MENU if you follow  
these steps:  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).  
2 Press and hold the Select and Return buttons and  
turn the printer power On (| ).  
3 Release the buttons when Performing Self Test  
appears on the operator panel display.  
When the printer self test completes, the CONFIG  
MENU displays.  
When you exit the CONFIG MENU, the printer restarts  
automatically and returns to the Ready state. See  
Exit Config Menu on page 107 for more information.  
Config Menu  
Menu Item  
Values  
Prt Quality Pgs  
Press Select to print the quality test pages. The first page contains a combination of graphics  
and text which always prints in English. The second and third pages contain graphics only.  
Note: PAPER SIZE must be set to Letter, Legal, or A-4 to print quality test pages. See PAPER  
SIZE on page 45 for more information.  
Panel Menus  
Buffered Jobs  
Disable  
Enable*  
Discard  
Select Discard to delete all print jobs stored in the print buffer.  
The message Formatting Disk briefly appears while the buffered jobs are being discarded.  
See Formatting Disk on page 153 for more information.  
*Factory default  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Config Menu (continued)  
Menu Item  
Values  
Factory Defaults  
Restore All  
If you select Restore All:  
All downloaded resources (fonts, macros, symbol sets) in printer memory (RAM) are  
deleted. (Resources residing in flash memory or on the hard disk option are unaffected.)  
All menu settings are returned to the factory default values except:  
Display Language (SETUP MENU) which is the operator panel display language.  
All settings in the PARALLEL MENU, SERIAL MENU, NETWORK MENU, INFRARED  
MENU, LOCALTALK MENU, USB MENU, and FAX MENU.  
The message Restoring Factory Defaults briefly appears while the printer restores the factory  
default settings. See Restoring Factory Defaults on page 157 for more information.  
NARROW MEDIA  
Plain Width  
Card Stock Width  
Trnsprncy Width  
Labels Width  
Bond Width  
Letterhead Width  
Preprinted Width  
Colored Width  
Envelope Width  
Custom 1 Width  
Custom 2 Width  
Custom 3 Width  
Custom 4 Width  
Custom 5 Width  
Custom 6 Width  
Each of the above menu items support the following values as a second menu:  
Normal*  
Narrow  
Set NARROW MEDIA to Narrow when using print material less than 172 mm (6.77 in.) in width,  
so the printer can adjust its speed, thus prolonging the life of the fuser.  
Custom x Width refers to special types of print materials. You can change the names through a  
utility, such as MarkVision. If a user-defined name is available, the name displays instead of  
Custom x Width, where x represents a number 1 through 6. The user-defined name is  
truncated to 16 characters.  
Exit Config Menu  
*Factory default  
Press Select to exit the CONFIG MENU. The printer automatically restarts and returns to the  
Ready state.  
Operator Panel Menus  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Understanding The Print and Hold function lets you delay the printing of  
a job, print it later, and ask for additional copies.  
Print and  
Hold Jobs  
The types of Print and Hold jobs are:  
Note: The Print and Hold func-  
tion requires a total of 8MB or  
more of memory. We recom-  
mend installing 16MB or more of  
memory and a hard disk option.  
Confidential Job  
Repeat Print Job  
Reserve Print Job  
Verify Print Job  
In the JOB MENU, there are two categories or menu items  
of Print and Hold jobs:  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
HELD JOBS  
Repeat Print job, Reserve Print job, and Verify Print job are  
grouped into the category called Held Jobs.  
You select the type of job you want from your software  
application or printer driver. To access your jobs once they  
are sent to print, you must use the operator panel or the  
remote operator panel in MarkVision to enter the JOB  
MENU.  
Confidential Jobs  
When you send a Confidential Job, the printer formats  
your job and holds the job in memory. The printer delays  
the printing of your job until you enter a PIN assigned to  
the job. You enter the number through the operator panel.  
page 111 for more information.  
For more information about Confidential Jobs, see  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB on page 60.  
To print all Confidential Jobs, see Print All Jobs on  
To print a specific Confidential Job, see PRINT A JOB  
To print additional copies of a Confidential Job, see  
PRINT COPIES on page 64.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
To delete all Confidential Jobs, see Delete All Jobs on  
To delete a specific Confidential Job, see  
DELETE A JOB on page 63.  
Held Jobs  
Held Jobs refers any of the following types of jobs: Repeat  
Print job, Reserve Print job, and Verify Print job.  
Repeat Print Job  
When you create a Repeat Print job, the job formats and  
prints, but the printer stores the job in memory so you can  
print additional copies of the job at a later time. As long as  
the job remains stored in memory, you may print addi-  
tional copies. Repeat Jobs are automatically deleted when  
the printer requires extra memory to process additional  
jobs or when the number of Repeat Jobs stored exceeds the  
value of the setting for Print and Hold Repeat Job Limit. For  
more information about this setting, refer to the Technical  
Reference.  
Reserve Print Job  
When you create a Reserve Print job, the job formats, but  
does not print. The printer stores the job in memory so  
you can print the job at a later time. All pages in the job are  
held in memory until you activate printing by using the  
operator panel to select Print All Jobs or PRINT A JOB.  
Reserve Print jobs are not deleted from memory when the  
job prints. To delete a Reserve Print job, you must request  
DELETE A JOB using the operator panel.  
Understanding Print and Hold Jobs  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Verify Print Job  
When you create a Verify Print job, the job formats, and  
one copy of the job prints. Additional requested copies are  
held in printer memory. You specify the number of copies  
you want when you send the job from the printer driver.  
This allows you to examine the first copy to see if it is sat-  
isfactory before you print the other copies.  
If the job is unsatisfactory, you would not want the other  
copies to print. To delete the job, you must select the  
DELETE A JOB value, and select this job to delete it. See  
DELETE A JOB on page 68 for more information.  
If the job is satisfactory, you can change the number of  
copies to print or print the number of copies already set in  
the printer driver.  
To change the number of remaining copies to print:  
1 Select PRINT COPIES.  
2 Select the specific job.  
3 At the Copies prompt, change the number of copies  
to print from the number set in the printer driver  
and press Select.  
4 Press Return until you exit the menus or press Go to  
exit the menus. Once the printer exits the menus  
and returns to an online state, the remaining copies  
print.  
Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from  
printer memory. For more information, see PRINT  
To print the number of copies set in the printer driver:  
1 Select PRINT A JOB.  
2 Select the specific job. The remaining copies print.  
Once all copies are printed, the job is deleted from  
printer memory. For more information, see PRINT A  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing and Deleting  
Held Jobs  
Once you have sent a Repeat Print job, a Reserve Print job,  
or a Verify Print job from the software application or the  
printer driver and have selected a value in the HELD JOBS  
menu item, the jobs are displayed on the operator panel in  
lists. You may choose to delete all, delete one or more indi-  
vidually, print all, print one or more individually, or print  
multiple copies of a job.  
To print all Held Jobs, see Print All Jobs on page 67.  
To print one or more Held Jobs by selecting them  
individually, see PRINT A JOB on page 67.  
To print additional copies of a Held Job, see PRINT  
To delete all Held Jobs, see Delete All Jobs on page  
68.  
To delete one or more Held Jobs by selecting them  
individually, see DELETE A JOB on page 68.  
Entering a Once you send a Confidential Job from your software  
application or printer driver, it is processed and held in  
printer memory. A Personal Identification Number (PIN)  
is paired with the print job in printer memory.  
Personal  
Identification  
Number (PIN)  
Entry of the PIN using the operator panel is required to  
delete or print a Confidential Job.  
When you want to access your Confidential Job held in  
printer memory, you:  
1 Press Menu> to enter the menus and go to the JOB  
MENU.  
If JOB MENU is on the first line of the display, con-  
tinue with step 2. If JOB MENU is on the second line,  
press Select.  
2 Continue to press and release Menu> until you see  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB on the second line of the dis-  
play.  
Entering a Personal Identification Number (PIN)  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
3 Press Select.  
The following prompt appears on the display:  
Enter PIN:  
=____  
You are required to enter the four-digit PIN associ-  
ated with your Confidential Job next to the equal  
sign (=). Each digit must be a number from 1 to 6.  
At this point, the buttons on the operator panel  
cease to function as before, such as scrolling  
through the menus. You press the numbers on the  
operator panel like pressing numbers on a calcula-  
tor. To simplify the operator panel, the illustration  
shows just the numbers and not the names of the  
operator panel buttons.  
As you press each button to enter each digit of your  
PIN, an asterisk (*) appears on the display.  
If you make a mistake entering your PIN, for  
instance, if you enter a number incorrectly, con-  
tinue to press any of the buttons until the mes-  
sage No Jobs Found. Retry? displays. Press Go to  
refresh the operator panel and the Enter PIN:  
prompt displays again.  
If you enter a PIN that does not match any Confi-  
dential Job in printer memory, the message  
No Jobs Found. Retry? displays. Press Go to  
refresh the operator panel and display the  
Enter PIN: prompt again or press Stop to cancel  
the entry of a PIN.  
Once you successfully enter the PIN, the printer  
checks the PIN with each stored PIN associated  
with each Confidential Job in printer memory. If the  
number matches, you are given access to the next  
level of the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item where  
you can select to print or delete jobs matching the  
PIN.  
Note: If you enter the Enter  
PIN prompt in error or need to  
exit from this prompt, you must  
wait until the No Jobs Found.  
Retry? message displays and  
then press Stop.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Print and Hold A lightning bolt symbol displays on the operator panel to  
indicate a formatting error occurred on at least one type of  
Print and Hold job. It looks like this:  
Formatting Errors  
When this type of error occurs, a portion of the processed  
job may still print, so the printer does not discard the  
entire job. Instead the lightning bolt displays to tell you  
that there is a formatting error on the particular job.  
Note: For documentation pur-  
poses, Print and Hold jobs refers  
to any of the following jobs: Con-  
fidential Job, Repeat Print Job,  
Reserve Print Job, and Verify  
Print Job.  
When any values are selected from either the CONFIDEN-  
TIAL JOB menu item or the HELD JOBS menu item, the  
symbol displays next to the value if at least one job experi-  
ences a formatting error as shown:  
HELD JOBS  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
Print All Jobs  
Print All Jobs  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
PRINT A JOB  
HELD JOBS  
PRINT A JOB  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
Delete All Jobs  
HELD JOBS  
Delete All Jobs  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
DELETE A JOB  
HELD JOBS  
DELETE A JOB  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB  
PRINT COPIES  
HELD JOBS  
PRINT COPIES  
Print and Hold Formatting Errors  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Once you select PRINT A JOB, DELETE A JOB, or  
PRINT COPIES values in the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item  
or the HELD JOBS menu item, the lightning bolt displays  
by the value if the currently displayed job experiences a  
formatting error. For example, if three jobs are sent to print  
and the second job experiences a formatting error, when  
you select PRINT COPIES, the operator panel displays as  
follows as you use the Menu> button to scroll to each job:  
PRINT COPIES  
Job #1  
PRINT COPIES  
Job #2  
PRINT COPIES  
Job #3  
The lightning bolt only displays for the second job since it  
is the only job that encountered a formatting error.  
Chapter 3: Using the Operator Panel and Menus  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using Print  
Materials  
4
This chapter provides specifications and guidelines for  
each type of print material that can be used with your  
printer, as well as important information about the paper  
sources and the output bins.  
Multipurpose  
Feeder  
Your printer has two standard paper sources, the  
250-sheet input tray and the multipurpose feeder, and two  
output bins, providing high quality printing on a variety  
of print materials from different paper sources.  
Load the print material you use for the majority of your  
print jobs in the 250-sheet input tray.  
Reserve the multipurpose feeder for when you print on  
different sizes and types of print material, such as card  
stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards, and enve-  
lopes. You may also want to use the multipurpose feeder  
for single page print jobs on letterhead, or other special  
print material you do not keep in an input tray.  
250-Sheet Input Tray  
Optional 500-Sheet Drawer  
Note: You may purchase an  
optional 500-sheet drawer as a  
paper source. See Optional  
for installation information.  
Using Print Materials  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Paper Sources The following table details the types and quantities of  
media you can load in each of the paper sources. For more  
and Sizes  
information about selecting specific print material for use  
list of the print material and envelope sizes your printer  
supports.  
Note: For detailed information  
about print material characteris-  
tics, refer to the Card Stock &  
Label Guide on the CD that  
comes with your printer.  
Paper Source Specifications  
Paper  
1
2
Source  
Media  
Sizes  
Weight  
Capacity  
2
2
Tray 1  
(250-sheet input  
tray)  
Paper, labels,  
transparencies  
A4, JIS B5, letter, legal,  
executive  
60 to 90 g/m  
(16 to 24 lb)  
250 sheets paper  
3
up to 100 labels  
50 transparencies  
500 sheets paper  
Tray 2  
(optional 500-sheet  
drawer)  
Paper only  
A4, JIS B5, letter, legal,  
executive  
60 to 90 g/m  
(16 to 24 lb)  
2
Multipurpose feeder Paper, envelopes,  
labels, transparencies,  
Minimum: 69.85 x 127 mm 60 to 163 g/m 100 sheets paper  
5
(2.75 x 5.0 in.)  
(16 to 43 lb)  
10 envelopes  
4
card stock  
Maximum: 215.9 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
30 labels  
20 transparencies  
10 sheets card stock  
Supports all sizes listed in  
Dimensionstable on  
1
This refers to paper only. For weights of other print materials, refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide for more infor-  
mation.  
2
3
4
5
For 20 lb print material, unless otherwise noted.  
Refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide for more information.  
3 x 5 in. and 4 x 6 in. index cards must exit to the rear output bin.  
Print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length must exit to the rear output bin.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
The following table lists the paper and envelope sizes you  
can use with your printer.  
Paper and Envelope Dimensions  
Paper  
Dimensions  
Envelope  
Dimensions  
A4  
210 x 297 mm  
(8.27 x 11.7 in.)  
7 3/4 Envelope  
(Monarch)  
98.4 x 190.5 mm  
(3.875 x 7.5 in.)  
A5  
148 x 210 mm  
(5.83 x 8.27 in.)  
9 Envelope  
98.4 x 225.4 mm  
(3.875 x 8.875 in.)  
(Multipurpose feeder only)  
JIS B5  
Letter  
182 x 257 mm  
(7.17 x 10.12 in.)  
10 Envelope  
(Com-10)  
104.8 x 241.3 mm  
(4.125 x 9.5 in.)  
215.9 x 279.4 mm  
(8.5 x 11 in.)  
DL Envelope  
C5 Envelope  
B5 Envelope  
Other Envelope  
110 x 220 mm  
(4.33 x 8.66 in.)  
Legal  
215.9 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
162 x 229 mm  
(6.38 x 9.01 in.)  
Executive  
184.2 x 266.7 mm  
(7.25 x 10.5 in.)  
176 x 250 mm  
(6.93 x 9.84 in.)  
1
2
Universal  
(Multipurpose feeder only)  
215.9 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.)  
229.11 x 356 mm  
(9.02 x 14 in.)  
1
Select this value when using a non-standard size sheet of print material. The printer formats the page for the  
maximum size (8.5 x 14 in.). Set the actual size from your software application.  
2
Select this value when using a non-standard size of envelope. The printer formats the envelope for the maximum  
size (9.02 x 14 in.). Set the actual size from your software application.  
Paper Sources and Sizes  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Print Material Selecting the appropriate print material (paper, transpar-  
encies, envelopes, labels, and card stock) for your printer  
helps you avoid printing problems.  
Guidelines  
The following sections contain guidelines for choosing the  
correct print material for your printer.  
Note: For detailed information  
about print material characteris-  
tics, refer to the Card Stock &  
Label Guide on the CD that  
comes with your printer.  
Paper  
For the best print quality, use 75 g/ m2 (20 lb) xerographic,  
grain long paper. Try a sample of any paper you are con-  
sidering using with the printer before buying large quanti-  
ties.  
When loading paper, note the recommended print side on  
the paper package, and load paper accordingly. See  
instructions.  
The following papers are not recommended for use with  
your printer:  
Paper with a rough or heavily textured surface  
Coated papers, such as erasable bond  
Preprinted papers manufactured with chemicals  
that may contaminate the printer  
Multiple-part forms  
Synthetic papers  
Thermal papers  
Recycled paper having a weight less than 75 g/ m2  
(20 lb)  
Letterhead  
Preprinted papers such as letterhead must be able to with-  
stand temperatures up to 200°C (392°F) without melting  
or releasing hazardous emissions. Use inks that are not  
affected by the resin in toner or the silicone in the fuser.  
Inks that are oxidation-set or oil-based should meet these  
requirements; latex inks might not.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Transparencies  
You can feed transparencies from the 250-sheet input tray  
or the multipurpose feeder. Try a sample of any transpar-  
encies you are considering using with the printer before  
buying large quantities.  
Do not load transparencies in the optional 500-sheet  
drawer. To load transparencies in the 250-sheet input tray,  
see page 124. To load transparencies in the multipurpose  
feeder, see page 141.  
When printing on transparencies:  
Warning! When printing on  
transparencies, be sure to set  
the PAPER TYPE to Transpar-  
ency from the printer driver, and  
from either the operator panel or  
from MarkVision to avoid dam-  
aging your printer.  
Use transparencies designed specifically for laser  
printers. Transparencies must be able to withstand  
temperatures of 175°C (347°F) without melting, dis-  
coloring or releasing hazardous emissions.  
To prevent print quality problems, avoid getting fin-  
gerprints on the transparencies.  
Before loading transparencies, fan the stack to pre-  
vent sheets from sticking together.  
Envelopes  
You can load up to 10 envelopes in the multipurpose  
feeder. Try a sample of any envelopes you are considering  
using with the printer before buying large quantities. See  
page 141 for loading instructions.  
When printing on envelopes:  
Note: When printing on enve-  
lopes, be sure to set the PAPER  
SOURCE to MP Feeder or  
Manual Env, set the PAPER TYPE  
to Envelope, and select the cor-  
rect envelope size from the  
printer driver, and from either the  
operator panel or from  
Use envelopes made from 75 to 105 g/ m2 (20 to  
28 lb) bond paper. For best performance and fewer  
paper jams, do not use envelopes that:  
Have excessive curl.  
Are stuck together.  
Are damaged in any way.  
Contain windows, holes, perforations, cutouts or  
embossing.  
MarkVision.  
Use metal clasps, string ties, or metal folding  
bars.  
Have postage stamps attached.  
Have any exposed adhesive when the flap is in  
the sealed or closed position.  
Print Material Guidelines  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Use envelopes that can withstand temperatures of  
205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling,  
wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions.  
Adjust the right paper guide to fit the width of the  
envelopes.  
Load envelopes with the flap side down and the  
short edge nearest the return address positioned to  
enter the printer first. See page 147 for an illustra-  
tion for loading envelopes.  
If you are feeding self-sealing envelopes, open the  
rear output bin door so envelopes feed straight out  
the back of the printer. The rear output bin holds  
about 10 envelopes.  
Labels  
Your printer can print on many labels designed for use  
with laser printers. These labels are supplied in letter-size  
and A4-size sheets. Label adhesives, face sheet (printable  
stock), and topcoats must be able to withstand tempera-  
tures of 205°C (401°F) and pressure of 25 pounds per  
square inch (psi).  
Try a sample of any labels you are considering using with  
the printer before purchasing a large quantity.  
For detailed information on label printing, characteristics  
and design, refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide on the CD  
that comes with your printer.  
When printing on labels:  
Note: When printing on labels,  
be sure to set the PAPER TYPE  
to Labels from the printer driver,  
and from either the operator  
panel or from MarkVision.  
Do not load labels together with paper or transpar-  
encies in the same paper source.  
Do not use label sheets with a slick backing material.  
Do not print within 1 mm (0.040 in.) of the die cut.  
Use full label sheets. Partial sheets may cause labels  
to peel off during printing, resulting in a paper jam.  
Partial sheets will also contaminate your printer  
and your cartridge with adhesive, and could void  
your printer and cartridge warranties.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Use labels that can withstand temperatures of 205°C  
(401°F) without sealing, excessive curling, wrin-  
kling, or releasing hazardous emissions.  
Do not print within 1 mm (0.040 in.) of the edge of  
the label, of the perforations, or between die-cuts of  
the label.  
Do not use label sheets that have adhesive to the  
edge of the sheet. We recommend zone coating of  
the adhesive at least 1 mm (0.040 in.) away from  
edges. Adhesive material will contaminate your  
printer and could void your warranty.  
If zone coating of the adhesive is not possible, a  
3 mm (0.125 in.) strip should be removed on the  
leading and driver edge, and a non-oozing adhesive  
should be used.  
Remove a 3 mm (0.125 in.) strip from the leading  
edge to prevent labels from peeling inside the  
printer.  
Portrait orientation is preferred, especially when  
printing bar codes.  
Do not use labels that have exposed adhesive.  
You may feed vinyl labels from the 250-sheet input  
tray and the multipurpose feeder.  
After continuously printing approximately 10,000 pages  
of labels (or each time you replace the print cartridge),  
complete the following steps to maintain printer feeding  
reliability:  
1 Print 5 sheets of paper.  
2 Wait approximately 5 seconds.  
3 Print 5 more sheets of paper.  
Print Material Guidelines  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Card Stock Card stock is single ply, and has a large array of proper-  
ties, such as the orientation of paper fibers and texture,  
that can significantly affect the print quality.  
Guidelines  
Try a sample of any card stock you are considering using  
with the printer before purchasing a large quantity.  
See page 116 for information on the preferred weight of  
print materials.  
When printing on card stock:  
Note: When printing on card  
stock, be sure to set the PAPER  
TYPE to Card Stock from the  
printer driver, and from either the  
operator panel or from MarkVi-  
sion.  
Use card stock that can withstand temperatures of  
205°C (401°F) without sealing, excessive curling,  
wrinkling, or releasing hazardous emissions.  
Do not use preprinted card stock manufactured  
with chemicals that may contaminate the printer.  
Preprinting introduces semi-liquid and volatile  
components in the printer.  
Do not use card stock that is perforated or creased. It  
may cause paper jams.  
We recommend the use of grain short card stock.  
After printing approximately 10,000 pages of card stock  
(or each time you replace the print cartridge), complete  
the following steps to maintain printer feeding reliability:  
1 Print 5 sheets of paper.  
2 Wait approximately 5 seconds.  
3 Print 5 more sheets of paper.  
For detailed information on card stock printing, character-  
istics, and design, refer to the Card Stock & Label Guide on  
the CD.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Storing Print Use the following guidelines for proper print material  
storage:  
Material  
For best results, store print material in an environ-  
ment where the temperature is approximately 21°C  
(70°F) and the relative humidity is 40%.  
Store cartons of print material on a pallet or shelf,  
rather than directly on the floor.  
If you store individual packages of print material,  
make sure they rest on a flat surface so the edges do  
not buckle or curl.  
Do not place anything on top of the print material  
packages.  
Storing Print Material  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Loading Proper print material loading helps prevent paper jams  
and helps make your printing trouble-free.  
Print Material  
Do not remove input trays while a job is printing or while  
Busy displays on the operator panel. Doing so may cause a  
paper jam.  
Before loading print material, know the recommended  
print side of the print material you are using. This infor-  
mation is usually indicated on the print material package.  
Loading an  
Input Tray  
Your printer has one standard 250-sheet input tray that  
holds five paper sizes: A4, B5, LTR (Letter), LGL (Legal),  
and EXE (Executive). The 250-sheet input tray also holds  
labels or transparencies.  
You may purchase an optional 500-sheet drawer as a  
page 223 for installation information.  
To load print material in an input tray:  
1 Pull the input tray straight out of the printer.  
If you are loading the 250-sheet input tray, pull the  
input tray straight out and remove it completely  
from the printer.  
If you are loading the input tray for the optional  
500-sheet drawer, pull the input tray straight out  
and remove it completely from the support unit.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
2 Press down on the metal plate until it locks into  
place.  
The metal plate remains stationary on the inside  
bottom of the input tray.  
3 Move the length guide to the correct position for  
Paper Size  
Indicators  
Length Guide  
the size print material you are loading.  
For the 250-sheet input tray, press down on the  
length guide tab with one hand, and with the  
other hand slide the length guide to the correct  
position for the size print material you are load-  
ing.  
Length  
Guide  
Tab  
Paper Size  
Indicators  
Loading Print Material  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
For the 500-sheet input tray, lift the length guide  
straight up out of the input tray and replace it in  
the correct position.  
Length Guide  
Paper Size  
Indicators  
Insert the tabs located on each end of the length  
guide into the slots on the side of the input tray.  
Note: These examples show  
how to adjust for letter-size  
paper (LTR). The paper size  
indicators are paper size abbre-  
viations used for placement of  
the length guide as shown.  
4 Press down on the width guide tab and slide the  
width guide to the far right side of the input tray  
as shown.  
Width Guide Tab  
Width Guide  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
5 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, then  
fan them. Do not fold or crease the print material.  
Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
6 Place the print material against the left side of the  
input tray and insert it under the metal stop.  
Make sure the recommended print side is face down  
and the front edge is placed toward the front of the  
input tray.  
For information on loading letterhead, see Printing  
Metal Stop  
Note: Make sure the print  
material fits easily under the  
metal stop and is not bent or  
wrinkled. Do not raise the metal  
stop or force print material under  
the metal stop.  
Loading Print Material  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7 Do not exceed the maximum stack height indi-  
cated by the line under the arrows.  
Note: Overfilling the input tray  
may cause paper jams.  
8 Push on the right side of the width guide to move  
it to the left until it lightly touches the edge of the  
print material.  
Width Guide  
Note: Sliding the width guide  
too tight against the print mate-  
rial may cause misfeeds.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
9 Insert the input tray.  
Slide the input tray all the way into the printer until  
it snaps into place.  
Slide the 500-sheet input tray all the way into the  
support unit.  
If an error message displays, see Understanding  
10 Send your job to print.  
For information on duplexing, see Manual Duplex  
Loading Print Material  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading the  
Multipurpose Feeder  
Your printer has one standard multipurpose feeder that  
holds several sizes and types of print material, such as  
paper, card stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards,  
and envelopes. You can load approximately 100 sheets of  
75 g/m2 (20 lb) paper at a time. You can also load approxi-  
mately 10 envelopes or 20 transparencies at a time.  
You may also want to use the multipurpose feeder for sin-  
gle page print jobs on letterhead or other special print  
material you do not keep in an input tray.  
Note: When printing from the  
multipurpose feeder, be sure to  
set the PAPER SIZE and PAPER  
TYPE for the MP Feeder menu  
item. Also select the paper size  
and type from your software  
application.  
For information on the types of print material that you can  
use with the multipurpose feeder, see Paper Sources  
and Sizeson page 116. For more information about using  
the multipurpose feeder, see Multipurpose Feederon  
Complete the following instructions to load print material  
in the multipurpose feeder:  
1 Open the multipurpose feeder door. See Opening  
information.  
2 Slide the paper width guide to the far right side of  
the multipurpose feeder.  
Paper  
Width Guide  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3 Flex the sheets back and forth to loosen them, then  
fan them. Do not fold or crease the print material.  
Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Note: Do not load different  
sizes or types of print material in  
the multipurpose feeder at the  
same time. Doing so may cause  
a paper jam.  
4 Locate the stack height limiter on the left side of  
the printer.  
5 Place the print material against the left side of the  
multipurpose feeder with the recommended print  
side face up and the top edge going in first toward  
the printer.  
Stack Height Limiter  
Note: Do not exceed the maxi-  
mum stack height limiter located  
on the left side of the multipur-  
pose feeder.  
Loading Print Material  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6 Slide the print material into the multipurpose  
feeder as far as it will go. Do not force it. Forcing  
print material could cause a paper jam.  
7 Slide the paper width guide to the left until it  
lightly touches the edge of the print material.  
Paper  
Width Guide  
Make sure the print material fits loosely in the mul-  
tipurpose feeder and is not bent or wrinkled. Do not  
overload the multipurpose feeder.  
8 Send your job to print.  
For information on duplexing, see Manual Duplex  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Using the You printer has two standard paper exits. The following  
sections explain how to use the printer output bins.  
Paper Exits  
(Output Bins)  
Using the  
Standard Output Bin  
The standard output bin holds 250 sheets of print material  
and is located on top of the printer. The printer automati-  
cally sends print jobs to the standard output bin.  
The standard output bin collates print jobs face down.  
Standard Output Bin  
Using the Paper Exits (Output Bins)  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Using the  
Rear Output Bin  
You may want to use the rear output bin when you print on  
different sizes and types of print material, such as paper, card  
stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards, and envelopes.  
The rear output bin holds 20 sheets of paper. For information  
on other types of print material, refer to the Card Stock & Label  
Guide.  
The printer automatically sends print jobs to the rear out-  
put bin when you open it. The rear output bin reverse col-  
lates print jobs face up.  
Note: Print material that is  
165.1 mm (6.5 in.) or less in  
length must exit to the rear out-  
put bin.  
1 Locate the rear output bin door as shown.  
Handhold  
Rear Output  
Bin Door  
2 Pull the handhold to open the rear output bin.  
3 Close the rear output bin door when you finish  
using it.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Printing on Check with the manufacturer or vendor to determine  
whether the preprinted letterhead you have chosen is  
acceptable for laser printers.  
Letterhead  
Page orientation is important when printing on letterhead.  
Use the following table for help when loading letterhead  
in the paper sources.  
Orienting Letterhead  
Top of page  
Tray  
Print side Portrait  
Landscape  
Tray 1  
(250-sheet input tray)  
Face down Front of tray Left side of  
(nearest tray tray  
handle)  
Tray 2  
(optional 500-sheet  
drawer)  
Multipurpose feeder  
(including feeding  
individual sheets)  
Face up  
Rear of tray Left side of  
(enters the  
printer first)  
tray  
Tray Linking If you are using the same size and type of print material in  
all paper sources (input trays and the multipurpose  
feeder) and the PAPER MENU settings for the sources are  
the same, the automatic tray linking feature is enabled.  
For example, if you have the same size and type print  
material loaded in the standard 250-sheet tray and the  
optional 500-sheet drawer, the printer will select print  
material from one tray when the other becomes empty.  
If you load the same size print material in each tray, make  
sure the print material is all the same type. If you use dif-  
ferent print material in the trays, each source with a differ-  
ent print material must have the PAPER TYPE set to a  
unique value to disable the automatic tray linking feature.  
See PAPER TYPE on page 47 for more information.  
Printing on Letterhead  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Manual Duplex Manual duplex printing lets you print on both sides of  
paper and card stock.  
Printing  
Manual duplexing does not damage your printer, but  
print quality and feed reliability may vary when printing  
on the other side of the page.  
To print on both sides of paper and card stock (called  
duplex printing or two-sided printing), print the first side of  
the print material like any other print job. When printing  
on the other side of the page, set PAPER WEIGHT to Heavy  
in the PAPER MENU to achieve the best results.  
Make sure the placement or orientation of the print mate-  
rial is correct.  
Duplex Printing from  
the Multipurpose  
Feeder  
When printing letterhead paper from the multipurpose  
feeder, load it with the design face up, so the top edge of  
the sheet with the logo enters the printer first.  
To print the second side of the sheet, load the printed side  
face down with the top edge of the sheet facing toward the  
printer.  
Duplex Printing from  
the Trays  
When printing letterhead paper from the trays, load it  
with the design face down with the top edge of the sheet  
facing toward the front of the printer.  
To print the second side of the sheet, load the printed side  
face up with the top edge of the sheet facing toward the  
front of the printer.  
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Avoiding If you follow the tips outlined in Print Material Guide-  
Paper Jams  
page 124, you are well on your way to trouble-free print-  
ing. If jams do occur, however, follow the steps outlined in  
Clearing Jamson page 183. If jams occur frequently,  
make sure you are following these tips:  
Use only recommended print materials. See Print  
Note: Make sure the PAPER  
TYPE, PAPER TEXTURE, and  
PAPER WEIGHT settings in the  
PAPER MENU are correct.  
If you need to load print material in a tray while a  
job is printing, press the Stop button and wait for  
the printer motors to idle before you remove the  
tray from the printer. After you reinstall the loaded  
tray, press Go to continue printing.  
Do not load wrinkled, creased, damp, or curled  
print material.  
Flex, fan, and straighten the print material before  
you load it. If jams do occur, try manually feeding  
the print material one sheet at a time.  
Do not overload the paper sources. Make sure the  
print material does not exceed the maximum height  
indicated on the stack height indicator.  
Do not use print material that you have cut or  
trimmed yourself.  
Do not mix print material sizes, weights, or types in  
the same paper source.  
Do not use coated print materials.  
Make sure the recommended print side is face down  
when loading all input trays and the recommended  
print side is face up when loading the multipurpose  
feeder.  
Keep print materials stored in an acceptable  
Do not remove input trays during a print job.  
Avoiding Paper Jams  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Chapter 4: Using Print Materials  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Multipurpose  
Feeder  
5
The multipurpose feeder is located on the front of your  
printer. It can be closed when you are not using it, making  
the printer more compact.  
You may want to use the multipurpose feeder when you  
print on different sizes and types of print material, such as  
paper, card stock, transparencies, postcards, note cards,  
and envelopes. You may also want to use the multipur-  
pose feeder for single-page print jobs on letterhead, or  
other special print material you do not keep in a paper  
tray.  
You can load approximately 100 sheets of 75 g/m2 (20 lb)  
print material at a time. You can load approximately 10  
envelopes or 20 transparencies at a time.  
The maximum stack height for the loading of any print  
material is 10 mm (0.4 in.). Print material is loaded face up  
in the multipurpose feeder.  
Multipurpose Feeder  
The multipurpose feeder accepts print material within the  
following dimensions:  
Minimum  
Maximum  
Width  
69.85 mm (2.75 in.)  
127 mm (5 in.)  
229.11 mm (9.02 in.)  
355.6 mm (14 in.)  
Length  
Multipurpose Feeder  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
When printing from the multipurpose feeder, be sure to  
set the PAPER SIZE and PAPER TYPE for the MP Feeder  
menu item. Also, select the size and paper type from your  
software application for the print material you have  
loaded. See PAPER SIZE on page 45 and PAPER TYPE on  
page 47 for more information.  
Multipurpose Follow these guidelines when using the multipurpose  
feeder:  
Feeder Guidelines  
Load only one size and type of print material or  
envelopes at a time in the multipurpose feeder.  
To achieve the best possible print quality, use only  
high-quality print material that is designed for use  
in laser printers. See Using Print Materialson  
page 115 for guidelines on selecting types of print  
material.  
To prevent paper jams, do not add print material to  
the multipurpose feeder until it is empty.  
Do not close the multipurpose feeder while a job is  
printing or while Busy displays on the operator  
panel. Doing so may cause a paper jam.  
Load print material with the top edge going into the  
multipurpose feeder first.  
Do not place objects on the multipurpose feeder.  
Also, avoid pressing down or applying excessive  
force on it.  
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Opening the To open the multipurpose feeder door:  
Multipurpose  
Feeder  
1 Push the lower release latch on the front left side  
to release the multipurpose feeder door.  
The multipurpose feeder door is the same as the  
lower front door.  
The multipurpose feeder door opens and stops in  
place.  
Opening the Multipurpose Feeder  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2 Locate the metal bar in the recessed area on the  
multipurpose feeder.  
3 Pull the metal bar straight out to extend the multi-  
purpose feeder.  
Note: Extend the metal bar to  
its full-length position to hold  
longer print material.  
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading the Proper loading prevents paper jams and ensures  
trouble-free printing. The following sections give detailed  
instructions for loading.  
Multipurpose  
Feeder  
Note: Note the recommended  
print side label on the print  
material package and load print  
material accordingly.  
Loading Print  
Material  
1 Locate the icons on the multipurpose feeder sur-  
face. These icons show the correct orientation for  
loading paper, as well as how to load letterhead and  
envelopes.  
Simplex  
Envelope  
Loading the Multipurpose Feeder  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
2 Slide the paper width guide to the far right side of  
Paper  
Width Guide  
the multipurpose feeder.  
3 Prepare specific print material for loading:  
Flex sheets of paper back and forth to loosen  
them, and then fan them. Do not fold or crease  
the paper. Straighten the edges on a level surface.  
Hold transparencies by the edges and fan them  
to prevent feeding failures.  
Note: Avoid touching the print  
side of the transparencies. Be  
careful not to scratch them.  
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Fan envelopes back and forth to loosen them. Do  
not fold or crease the envelopes. Straighten the  
edges on a level surface.  
4 Locate the stack height limiter on the left side of  
the multipurpose feeder.  
5 Place the print material against the left side of the  
multipurpose feeder. Do not mix different sizes and  
types of print material.  
Stack Height Limiter  
Loading the Multipurpose Feeder  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
6 Load specific print material:  
Load paper with the recommended print side  
face up and the top edge going in first as shown.  
Note: Do not exceed the maxi-  
mum stack height limiter located  
on the left side of the multipur-  
pose feeder. Overfilling the mul-  
tipurpose feeder may cause  
paper jams.  
Load letterhead with the design face up and the  
top edge going in first as shown.  
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Load transparencies with the recommended  
print side face up and the top edge going in first  
as shown.  
Load envelopes with the flap side down and the  
stamp area end going in last as shown.  
Do not feed stamped envelopes into the multi-  
purpose feeder. The stamp is shown for place-  
ment only.  
Note: For best results, self-  
sealing envelopes should exit to  
the rear output bin.  
Warning! Never use enve-  
lopes with clasps, snaps, win-  
dows, coated linings, or self-  
stick adhesives. These enve-  
lopes may severely damage the  
printer.  
Loading the Multipurpose Feeder  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
7 Slide the print material into the multipurpose  
feeder as far as it will go. Do not force it. Forcing  
print material could cause a paper jam.  
Note: If envelopes jam while  
printing, try reducing the number  
of envelopes you load.  
8 Slide the paper width guide to the left until it  
lightly touches the edge of the print material.  
Paper  
Width Guide  
Make sure the print material fits loosely in the mul-  
tipurpose feeder and is not bent or wrinkled. Do not  
overload the multipurpose feeder.  
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the After loading print material in the multipurpose feeder,  
select the paper source from your software application,  
and then select the paper size and type from both your  
software application and from the operator panel.  
Multipurpose  
Feeder  
To set the operator panel:  
Note: Software settings may  
override operator panel settings.  
1 Make sure the PAPER SIZE for the multipurpose  
feeder (MP Feeder Size) is set to the correct size for  
the print material you are loading.  
2 Make sure the PAPER TYPE for the multipurpose  
feeder (MP Feeder Type) is set to the correct value  
for the print material you are loading.  
3 Make sure the PAPER LENGTH for the PAPER TYPE  
in the multipurpose feeder is set to the correct  
value for the print material you are loading.  
Print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length must  
exit to the rear output bin. See Using the  
Rear Output Binon page 134 for more information.  
4 Press Go to return the printer to the Ready state.  
Using the Multipurpose Feeder  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Closing the When you finish printing with the multipurpose feeder:  
Multipurpose  
Feeder  
1 Remove all print material.  
2 Push the metal bar straight back to collapse the  
multipurpose feeder to its short-length position.  
3 Close the multipurpose feeder door.  
4 Close the rear output bin if you were printing on  
print material 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length.  
See page 134 for more information.  
Chapter 5: Multipurpose Feeder  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding  
Printer  
Messages  
6
This chapter describes the various messages that may  
appear on your operator panel display. Status messages  
give information about the current state of the printer.  
Attendance messages indicate printer errors that you must  
resolve. Service messages indicate printer failures that may  
require servicing.  
Note: For documentation pur-  
poses, Print and Hold jobs refers  
to any of the following jobs: Con-  
fidential Job, Reserve Print Job,  
Repeat Print Job, and Verify  
Print Job.  
Status Messages The first line (line 1) on the display provides information  
on the current state or status of the printer, as shown in the  
tables beginning on page 152. However in some cases, a  
message is long enough that it requires both lines to dis-  
play the entire message.  
Usually the second line (line 2) on the display provides  
additional information about printer status. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Status Messages  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Line 1 Messages  
Status Message  
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays  
Activating Menu  
Changes  
The printer is reset to activate a printer setting change.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Busy  
<warning>  
The printer is busy receiving, processing, or printing data. The printer indicator light  
blinks while the printer is processing data.  
The display shows one of the following items on line 1 while the printer processes  
data:  
A PJL RDYMSG, if it is defined  
A Network Printing Alliance (NPA) protocol job name, if one is defined  
The printer language  
Note: If you use a PJL RDYMSG command or an NPA protocol job name, a  
customized message may display instead of Busy.  
Note: The printer language appears on line 1 to the right of the Busy message.  
Press Stop to take the printer out of the Busy state. The Not Ready message  
displays. No more data is processed, but all print material in the printer paper path  
prints. Press Go to return to Busy and continue receiving, processing, or printing  
data.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Print or delete Print and Hold jobs. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU  
displays. Press Menu> or <Menu until CONFIDENTIAL JOB or HELD JOBS  
appears. Continue with the instructions for CONFIDENTIAL JOB on page 60 or  
HELD JOBS on page 65 to print all jobs, print a job, print copies, delete all jobs, or  
delete a job.  
For more information, refer to the Technical Reference.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Warning messages are displayed on line 2 of the operator panel. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Cancelling Job  
The printer is processing a request to cancel the current print job.  
Clearing Job  
Accounting Stat  
The printer is deleting all job statistics stored on the hard disk option.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Defragmenting  
DO NOT POWER OFF  
The printer is defragmenting the flash memory option to reclaim storage space  
occupied by deleted resources.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Status Message  
Deleting Jobs  
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays  
The printer is deleting one or more Print and Hold jobs. This message displays if you  
selected Delete All Jobs or DELETE A JOB, and there are no other print jobs selected  
for printing.  
Queuing and  
Deleting Jobs  
The printer is deleting one or more Print and Hold jobs and printing one or more Print  
and Hold jobs. This message displays if one or more print jobs are selected for  
deletion in the CONFIDENTIAL JOB and HELD JOBS menu items, and one or more  
print jobs are selected for printing.  
No button actions are possible while either of these messages displays.  
See Delete All Jobs on page 63 and on page 68 or DELETE A JOB on page 63 and on  
page 68 for more information.  
Disabling Menus  
Enabling Menus  
This message briefly displays after the operator panel menus have been disabled. See  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
If the operator panel menus are disabled, this message briefly displays after they are  
enabled. See Disabling the Operator Panel Menuson page 41 for more information.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Flushing Buffer  
Formatting Disk  
The printer is flushing corrupted print data and discarding the current print job.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
The hard disk option is formatting.  
This message also displays if you select the Discard value for the Buffered Jobs menu  
item in the CONFIG MENU.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.  
Formatting Flash  
The flash memory option is formatting.  
DO NOT POWER OFF  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.  
Invalid  
Network 1 Code  
This message displays if the code in the optional internal print server (also called an  
internal network adapter or INA) has not been programmed or if the code is not valid.  
You can download network code while this message displays.  
When this message appears, the Ready and Busy messages do not display until valid  
code is programmed into the optional internal print server.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Menus Disabled  
The printer menus are disabled. This message displays when Menu> or <Menu is  
pressed.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Status Messages  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                     
Status Message  
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays  
Network Card  
Busy  
The optional internal print server is being reset. The Network 1 Setup menu item in the  
NETWORK MENU is not available while this message displays.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Not Ready  
The printer is in the Not Ready state, which means it is not ready to receive or process  
data.  
Press Go to take the printer out of the Not Ready state.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Performing  
Self Test  
The printer is running the normal series of start-up tests after it is powered On (|).  
When the tests are complete, the printer returns to the Ready state.  
No button actions are possible while this message display.  
The printer is in Power Saver mode.  
Power Saver  
<warning>  
Press Go to take the printer out of Power Saver mode.  
Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.  
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays. No data is  
processed. Press Go to return the printer to Power Saver.  
Warning messages are displayed on line 2 of the operator panel. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Status Message  
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays  
Printing  
Directory List  
The printer is processing or printing a directory of all files stored in the flash memory  
option or on the hard disk option.  
Printing Font  
List  
The printer is processing or printing a list of all available fonts for the selected printer  
language.  
Printing Job  
The printer is processing or printing the Job Accounting Statistics.  
Accounting Stat  
Printing Menu  
Settings  
The printer is processing or printing the menu settings page. See Printing the Menu  
Settings Pageon page 39 for more information.  
The message displays until the function completes and the page prints.  
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays. No more  
data is processed, but all print material in the printer paper path prints. Press Go to  
return to the previous message.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Printing Quality  
Test Pages  
The printer is formatting the Print Quality Test Pages once Prt Quality Pgs is selected  
in the CONFIG MENU. Once the pages start printing, the Busy message displays.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
For more information about these pages, see Prt Quality Pgs on page 106.  
Program Flash  
DO NOT POWER OFF  
The printer is storing resources, fonts or macros, in the flash memory option. If infor-  
mation is written to the flash memory option and to the hard disk option at the same  
time, the Program Flash message displays.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.  
Programming Disk  
DO NOT POWER OFF  
The printer is storing resources, fonts or macros, on the hard disk option. If information  
is written to the flash memory option and to the hard disk option at the same time, the  
Program Flash message displays.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Note: Do not power Off (O) the printer while this message displays.  
Status Messages  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Status Message  
Queuing Jobs  
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays  
The printer is processing one or more Print and Hold jobs selected for printing. This  
message displays if you selected PRINT A JOB, Print All Jobs, or PRINT COPIES and  
no jobs are selected for deletion.  
Queuing and  
Deleting Jobs  
The printer is processing one or more Print and Hold jobs selected for printing and  
deleting one or more Print and Hold jobs. This message displays if you selected one or  
more jobs to print using PRINT A JOB, Print All Jobs, or PRINT COPIES values in the  
CONFIDENTIAL JOB or HELD JOBS menu items, and one or more jobs are selected  
for deletion.  
No button actions are possible while either of these messages displays.  
See PRINT A JOB on page 62 and on page 67, Print All Jobs on page 62 and on page  
67, or PRINT COPIES on page 64 and on page 69 for more information.  
Ready  
The printer is ready to receive and process data.  
<warning>  
Press Menu> or <Menu to take the printer out of the Ready state and enter the  
menus.  
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays. No data is  
processed. Press Go to return the printer to the Ready state.  
Note: If you use the PJL RDYMSG command, a customized message may display  
instead of Ready.  
Note: If Power Saver is set to On and is active, Power Saver displays instead of Ready.  
See Power Saver on page 154 for more information.  
For more information, refer to the Technical Reference.  
Warning messages are displayed on line 2 of the operator panel. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Ready  
<warning>  
Hex  
The printer is ready and Hex Trace mode is active. Hex Trace isolates the source of a  
print job problem. When Hex Trace is selected, all data sent to the printer prints in  
hexadecimal and character representation. Control codes print, but do not execute.  
Power Off (O) the printer to exit Hex Trace.  
Press Stop to take the printer offline. The Not Ready message displays, and no  
data is processed. Press Go to return the printer to the Ready state.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Warning messages are displayed on line 2 of the operator panel. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Status Message  
Meaning and Actions Allowed While Message Displays  
Res Reduced  
<warning>  
The resolution of the page is reduced from 600 dots per inch (dpi) to 300 dpi to prevent  
a 38 Memory Full error. Res Reduced displays for the duration of the current job. The  
printer indicator light blinks while the printer is processing data.  
Press Stop to take the printer out of the Res Reduced state. The Not Ready  
message displays. Press Go to return to Res Reduced.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Warning messages are displayed on line 2 of the operator panel. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Resetting the  
Printer  
The printer is deleting any print jobs in process and restoring all printer settings to user  
defaults.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Restoring  
Factory Defaults  
The printer is restoring factory defaults. Factory defaults are restored by selecting  
Factory Defaults in the UTILITIES MENU or by selecting Factory Defaults in the  
CONFIG MENU.  
See page 57 or page 107 for details about which printer settings are affected.  
No button actions are possible while this message displays.  
Waiting  
Waiting displays when one of the following occurs:  
<warning>  
The printer has received a page of data to print, but is waiting for an End of Job  
command, Form Feed command, or for additional data. Waiting displays until the  
Print Timeout occurs or additional data is received.  
When Collation is set to On, but the print job has not been canceled. Termination of  
the print job is required before page collated copies print.  
Note: The printer language appears on line 1 to the right of the Waiting message.  
Press Go to print the contents of the buffer.  
Press Stop to take the printer out of the Waiting state. The Not Ready message  
displays. Press Go to return to Waiting.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Warning messages are displayed on line 2 of the operator panel. See Warning  
Messageson page 158 for more information.  
Status Messages  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Warning Messages  
Warning messages give further information about printer  
status. The following is an example of a warning message  
displayed on the operator panel when the printer is in the  
Ready state:  
Ready  
Tray 1 Missing  
In this example, Tray 1 Missing is the warning message.  
The following table lists messages that appear on the sec-  
ond line of the operator panel display. If none of the fol-  
lowing conditions exist, line 2 of the operator panel  
display is blank.  
Status Message  
Meaning  
Fax 1  
The printer is processing a fax through the optional interface.  
The optional infrared interface is the active communication link.  
The optional LocalTalk interface is the active communication link.  
The optional network interface is the active communication link.  
The standard parallel interface is the active communication link.  
The optional parallel interface is the active communication link.  
The optional serial interface is the active communication link.  
The 250-sheet input tray is missing.  
Infrared 1  
LocalTalk 1  
Network 1  
Parallel  
Parallel 1  
Serial 1  
Tray 1 Missing  
Tray 1 Missing is available only if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed. See  
USB  
The standard USB interface is the active communication link.  
The optional USB interface is the active communication link.  
USB 1  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                       
Attendance Attendance messages indicate printer errors that you  
must resolve before you can continue printing. The mes-  
sages are listed in numerical then alphabetical order.  
Messages  
Note: For paper jam errors,  
the entire paper path must be  
cleared of print material. See  
more information.  
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
34 Short Paper  
The printer determines the paper length is too short to print the formatted data. This  
occurs when the printer does not know the actual paper size loaded in tray. This  
message also displays if you select Universal as a Paper Size setting and use print  
material too short for the page format.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing.  
Make sure the Paper Size setting in the PAPER MENU is correct for the size print  
material you are using. If the MP Feeder Size setting is set to Universal, make sure  
your print material is large enough.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
35 Res Save Off  
The printer lacks the memory needed to enable Resource Save. This message usually  
Deficient Memory  
indicates that too much memory is allocated for one or more of the printer link buffers.  
To enable Resource Save after this message displays:  
Install additional memory, or  
Set the link buffer back to Auto, and exit the menus to activate the link buffer  
changes. When Ready displays, enable Resource Save from the SETUP MENU.  
Press Go to disable Resource Save and continue printing.  
Attendance Messages  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
37 Insufficient  
Collation Area  
The printer memory used to store pages of data is too full to collate the rest of the print  
job.  
Press Go to clear the message, print the portion of the job already in memory, and  
begin collating the rest of the job.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
37 Insufficient  
Defrag Memory  
The printer memory used to store undeleted flash resources is too full to perform the  
flash memory defragment operation.  
Press Go to clear the message.  
To perform the defragment operation, you can:  
Delete fonts, macros, and other data in printer RAM.  
Install additional printer memory.  
37 Insufficient  
Memory  
The printer memory contains Print and Hold jobs, and is too full to continue processing  
the current job.  
Note: The messages, 37 Insufficient Memory and Held Jobs may be lost. Go/Stop?,  
display alternately on the operator panel until you do one of the following:  
Held Jobs may be  
lost.  
Go/Stop?  
Press Go to clear the messages and continue printing the current job. The printer  
frees memory by deleting all Print and Hold jobs. If the current job is a Print and  
Hold job, it is not deleted.  
Press Stop to clear the messages and continue printing the job. However, some  
data may not print or may not print correctly.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Attendance Message  
38 Memory Full  
Meaning and Required Action  
The printer is processing data, but the memory used to store pages is full.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data  
may not print or may not print correctly.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
After resetting the printer, reduce the complexity of the print job and send it to print  
again. To simplify the print job:  
Reduce the amount of text or graphics on a page.  
Reduce the print resolution.  
Delete unnecessary downloaded fonts or macros.  
Install additional printer memory to avoid future 38 Memory Full errors.  
39 Complex Page  
The page may not print correctly because the amount of text, graphics, or print infor-  
mation on the page is very complex.  
Set Page Protect in the SETUP MENU to On and send the print job again.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data  
may not print or may not print correctly. Try to simplify the print job.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
51 Defective  
Flash  
The printer detects a defective flash memory option. This message appears when you  
power On (|) the printer, or during format and write to flash operations.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. You must install a different flash  
memory option before you can perform any flash memory operations.  
Attendance Messages  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Attendance Message  
52 Flash Full  
Meaning and Required Action  
There is not enough free space in the flash memory option to store the data that was  
sent.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. Downloaded fonts and  
macros not previously stored in flash memory are deleted.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
53 Unformatted  
Flash  
The printer detects an unformatted flash memory option. This message appears when  
you power On (|) the printer.  
You must format the flash memory option before you can perform any flash memory  
operations. To format the flash memory option, select Format Flash from the  
UTILITIES MENU.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. If the error message remains,  
the flash memory option may be defective and need replacing.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
54 Serial  
Option 1 Error  
A serial interface error is detected (framing or parity) on the optional serial port. This  
error usually indicates the serial link has not been set up correctly. When the serial  
error displays, the reporting of other serial errors is suppressed until interface  
parameters are changed or the printer is reset.  
54 Std Par ENA  
Connection Lost  
Displays only during the printer power-on cycle to indicate the connection to an  
external print server (also called an external network adapter or ENA) is lost.  
54 Par 1 ENA  
Connection Lost  
54 Ser 1 Fax  
Connection Lost  
The serial port is configured to receive fax data, but the connection to the external  
modem has been lost. If the Fax Port menu item in the FAX MENU is not set to  
Disabled, the printer automatically assumes a modem is connected for fax processing.  
See Fax Menuon page 102 for more information.  
Check the interface to:  
Verify you are using the correct cable.  
Make sure the serial interface parameters (protocol, baud, parity, data bits) are  
correct.  
If one of these messages display:  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data  
may not print or may not print correctly.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
54 Network 1  
Software Error  
A network port is installed, but the software cannot establish communications with the  
port.  
Press Go to clear the message. The printer disables communications with the  
network.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Attendance Messages  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
55 Insufficient  
Fax Buffer  
The printer link buffer used to process data is too full to receive an incoming fax.  
This message usually displays when the printer is busy receiving, processing, or  
printing data from a host interface connection while fax data is being received through  
a serial interface port configured for fax processing.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing the job. However, some data  
may not print or may not print correctly.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
After this message displays, the connection between the printer and the sending fax  
machine is broken. The printer will not accept additional fax data until sufficient fax  
buffer space is made available. However, any fax data stored in the fax buffer is  
printed. See Fax Menuon page 102 for more information.  
56 Serial  
Port 1 Disabled  
Data is sent to the printer across the serial port, but the serial port is disabled. When  
the serial error displays, the reporting of other serial errors is suppressed until the  
menus are entered or the printer is reset.  
If this message displays:  
Make sure the Serial Buffer menu item in the SERIAL MENU is not set to Disabled.  
Press Go to clear the message. The printer discards any data received on the serial  
port.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
56 Std Parallel  
Port Disabled  
Data is sent to the printer through the parallel port, but the parallel port is disabled.  
When the error displays, the reporting of other errors is suppressed until the menus  
are entered or the printer is reset.  
56 Parallel  
Port 1 Disabled  
If one of these messages displays:  
Make sure the Parallel Buffer menu item in the PARALLEL MENU is not set to  
Disabled.  
Press Go to clear the message. The printer discards any data received through the  
parallel port.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
58 Too Many  
Flash Options  
The printer detects more than one flash option installed. Your printer can only have  
one flash option installed.  
Press Go to clear the error.  
Turn the printer power Off (O). Remove the extra option. Turn the printer power  
On (|). See Removing Memory Optionson page 210 for more information.  
61 Defective  
Disk  
The printer detects a defective hard disk option. This message appears when you  
power On (|) the printer, or during hard disk format or write operations.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. You must install a different hard  
disk option before you can perform any hard disk operations.  
62 Disk Full  
There is not enough free space in the hard disk option to store the data that was sent.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue processing. Any information not  
previously stored in the hard disk option is deleted.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
63 Unformatted  
Disk  
The printer detects an unformatted hard disk option. This message appears when you  
power On (|) the printer.  
You must format the hard disk option before you can perform any hard disk operations.  
To format the hard disk option, select Format Disk from the UTILITIES MENU.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. If the error message remains,  
the hard disk option may be defective and need replacing. Hard disk operations are  
not allowed until the defective disk is replaced and the new one is formatted.  
70 - 79 messages  
Reserved for messages relating to the optional internal print server.  
For more information, refer to the online documentation that comes with your printer.  
Also, refer to the documentation that comes with the optional internal print server.  
200 Paper Jam  
Remove Cartridge  
The printer detects a paper jam. Open the upper front door, remove the print cartridge,  
and gently remove the jammed print material. Reinstall the print cartridge and close  
for more information.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of  
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting  
does not guarantee the page will print.  
201 Paper Jam  
Remove Cartridge  
The printer detects a paper jam. Open the upper front door, remove the print cartridge,  
and gently remove the jammed print material. Reinstall the print cartridge and close  
for more information.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of  
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting  
does not guarantee the page will print.  
Attendance Messages  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
               
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
202 Paper Jam  
Open Rear Door  
The printer detects a paper jam behind the rear output bin door. Open the rear output  
bin door and gently remove the jammed print material. Close the rear output bin door.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of  
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting  
does not guarantee the page will print.  
Once the print job is complete, close the rear output bin door.  
203 Paper Jam  
Short Paper  
The printer detects a paper jam behind the rear output bin door. Open the rear output  
bin door and gently remove the jammed print material. Leave the rear output bin door  
open. Set PAPER LENGTH to Short from the operator panel. See 203 Paper Jam -  
Short Paperon page 190 for more information.  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of  
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting  
does not guarantee the page will print.  
Once the print job is complete, close the rear output bin door.  
250 Paper Jam  
Check MP Feeder  
The printer detects a paper jam in the multipurpose feeder. If the print material is  
visible from the front of the multipurpose feeder, pull it out gently. If only a small portion  
is visible, open the upper front door, remove the print cartridge, and remove the  
jammed print material. Reinstall the cartridge and close the upper front door. See 250  
Press Go to clear the message and continue printing. The printer prints a new copy of  
the page that jammed if Jam Recovery is set to On or Auto. However, the Auto setting  
does not guarantee the page will print.  
900-999 service  
messages  
These service messages indicate printer failures that may require service.  
When a service message occurs, the printer immediately stops printing. Turn the  
printer power Off (O), wait for about 10 seconds, and then turn the printer power  
On (|).  
If the service message recurs, call for service and report the message number and  
description of the problem.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Attendance Message  
Change <input source>  
Meaning and Required Action  
The printer requests a different print material than what is loaded in the tray or set in  
the PAPER SIZE or PAPER TYPE menus.  
<Custom Type Name>  
<size>  
Line 1 displays the input source (<input source>), which is one of the following items:  
<type><size>  
Tray 1  
Tray 2  
MP Feeder  
Note: Tray 2 only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.  
Line 2 displays one of the following items:  
<Custom Type Name>: A user-defined name for Custom Type 1 through 6. The  
name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display. Use the MarkVision utility to  
create Custom Type names. See Introducing MarkVisionon page 25 for more  
information.  
<size>: If the requested type matches the type currently in the paper source and the  
custom type name has not been defined by you, only the print material or envelope  
size (<size>) displays. The name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display.  
<type><size>: The requested type (<type>) is a type other than a custom type. The  
requested size (<size>) of print material or envelope displays. The type and size  
names are truncated to fit on the operator panel display.  
If you are using Tray 1 or Tray 2 when this message displays, you can:  
Load the requested size and type print material in the input source. Press Go to  
continue printing.  
Press Select to clear the message and continue printing on the print material  
installed in the input source.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
If you are using the multipurpose feeder when this message displays, you can:  
Load the requested size and type print material in the multipurpose feeder. The  
printer will clear the message and automatically continue printing.  
If the correct print material is already loaded in the multipurpose feeder, press Go.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Attendance Messages  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attendance Message  
Meaning and Required Action  
Check Tray 2  
Connection  
The printer has lost communication with the optional 500-sheet drawer.  
Communication may be lost if the optional 500-sheet drawer was removed from the  
printer, for example, to clear a paper jam. The optional 500-sheet drawer may still be  
attached to the printer, but may not be fully connected or may be experiencing a  
hardware failure.  
Note: This message only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.  
If this message displays:  
Reestablish communication by removing the optional 500-sheet drawer and  
reattaching it to the printer. See Installing the Optional Draweron page 223 for  
more information. When the optional 500-sheet drawer is recognized by the printer,  
the message clears.  
In case of a hardware failure, turn the printer power Off (O) and back On (|). If the  
error recurs, turn the printer power Off (O), remove the optional 500-sheet drawer,  
and call for service.  
Close Door or  
Insert Cartridge  
The upper front door is open or the print cartridge is not installed.  
Close the door or install the print cartridge, then close the door.  
Delete All Jobs.  
Go/Stop?  
The printer requests confirmation to delete all Print and Hold jobs. This message  
displays if Delete All Jobs is selected from the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or  
from the HELD JOBS menu item.  
Press Go to continue. The printer deletes all Print and Hold jobs.  
Press Stop to cancel this operation.  
See CONFIDENTIAL JOB on page 60 or HELD JOBS on page 65 for more information.  
Enter PIN:  
=____  
The printer requests you enter a four-digit Personal Identification Number (PIN)  
associated with your Confidential Job once you enter the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu  
item on the operator panel. You use the operator panel buttons to enter the number.  
mation.  
Files will be  
Lost. Go/Stop?  
This message displays when you change the Job Buffer Size setting on the operator  
panel. The printer must reformat the hard disk option. The message asks for confir-  
mation to continue and erase all files on the hard disk option.  
Press Go to continue. The hard disk option formats and the specified job buffer  
partition is created. The message Format Disk displays while the hard disk option  
formats.  
Press Stop to cancel this operation.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Attendance Message  
Insert Tray 1  
Meaning and Required Action  
This message displays when the printer needs to select print material from Tray 1  
(250-sheet input tray). The printer is requesting the 250-sheet input tray be inserted so  
it can continue printing. This may happen if you remove the 250-sheet input tray to fill  
it with print material while a job is printing.  
Note: This message only displays for Tray 1 if the optional 500-sheet drawer is  
installed. If the optional 500-sheet drawer is not installed and Tray 1 is removed from  
the printer after a job is sent to print, a Load <input source> message displays  
instead. See Load <input source> on page 170 for more information.  
To avoid this message, press Stop, wait for the job to stop printing, and then remove  
the 250-sheet input tray to fill it.  
When this message occurs:  
Insert Tray 1 to clear the message and continue printing the job.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Install Tray 2  
or Cancel Job  
The printer has lost communication with the optional 500-sheet drawer support unit.  
The support unit is not properly attached to the printer when you have sent a job to  
print.  
When this message occurs:  
Reattach the printer to the optional 500-sheet drawer support unit to clear the  
message and continue printing the job.  
1 Lift the printer by the handholds or ask someone to help you lift the printer. Make  
sure your fingers are not under the printer when you set it down.  
2 Place the printer on top of the support unit. Make sure the edges of the printer  
and the support unit are aligned properly.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Attendance Messages  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attendance Message  
Load <input source>  
Meaning and Required Action  
The printer is trying to feed print material from an input source it detects is empty.  
<Custom Type Name>  
<size>  
<type><size>  
Line 1 displays the input source (<input source>), which is one of the following items:  
Tray 1  
Tray 2  
MP Feeder  
Note: Tray 2 only displays if the optional 500-sheet drawer is installed.  
Line 2 displays one of the following items:  
<Custom Type Name>: A user-defined name for custom type 1 through 6. The  
name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display. Use the MarkVision utility to  
create custom type names. See Introducing MarkVisionon page 25 for more  
information.  
<size>: If the requested type matches the type currently in the tray and the custom  
type name has not been defined by you, only the print material or envelope size  
displays. The name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display.  
<type><size>: The requested type (<type>) is a type other than a custom type. The  
requested size <size> of print material or envelope displays. The type and size  
names are truncated to fit on the operator panel display.  
If you are using Tray 1 or Tray 2 when this message displays, you can:  
Load the requested size and type print material in the input source. Press Go to  
continue printing.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
If you are using the multipurpose feeder when this message displays, you can:  
Load the requested size and type print material in the multipurpose feeder. The  
printer will clear the message and automatically continue printing.  
If the correct print material is already loaded in the multipurpose feeder, press Go.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attendance Message  
Load Manual  
Meaning and Required Action  
The printer requests print material to be manually fed from the multipurpose feeder.  
Line 2 displays one of the following items:  
<Custom Type Name>  
<size>  
<type><size>  
<Custom Type Name>: A user-defined name for custom type 1 through 6. The  
name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display. Use the MarkVision utility to  
create custom type names. See Introducing MarkVisionon page 25 for more  
information.  
<size>: If the requested type matches the type currently in the tray and the custom  
type name has not been defined by you, only the print material or envelope size  
displays. The name is truncated to fit on the operator panel display.  
<type><size>: The requested type (<type>) is a type other than a custom type. The  
requested size (<size>) of print material or envelope displays. The type and size  
names are truncated to fit on the operator panel display.  
When this message displays you can:  
Load the requested size or type of print material in the multipurpose feeder. The  
printer automatically clears the message and continues printing.  
Press Go if the correct size and type print material is loaded in the multipurpose  
feeder.  
Press Select to clear the message and print on the print material installed in Tray 1  
or the optional Tray 2.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
No Jobs Found.  
Retry?  
The Personal Identification Number (PIN) you entered is not a PIN associated with any  
Confidential Job in printer memory.  
Press Go to enter another PIN.  
Press Stop to exit the PIN entry prompt.  
mation.  
Attendance Messages  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Attendance Message  
Open Rear Door  
Meaning and Required Action  
The print material in the multipurpose feeder is 152.4 mm (6 in.) or less in length and  
the rear output bin door is not open.  
When this message displays you can:  
Open the rear output bin door to let the print material exit.  
Cancel the current job. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press  
Menu> or <Menu until Cancel Job appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Reset the printer. Press Menu> or <Menu. The JOB MENU displays. Press Menu>  
or <Menu until Reset Printer appears on the second line of the operator panel  
display. Press Select.  
Note: Resetting the printer deletes all current data from the print buffer, including all  
Print and Hold jobs. See Reset Printer on page 70 for more information.  
Operation Failed  
Jobs on Disk  
This message displays when the printer receives a request to format the hard disk  
option or modify the Job Buffer Size setting and Print and Hold jobs are currently  
stored on the hard disk option.  
Operation Failed  
Faxes on Disk  
This message displays when the printer receives a request to format the hard disk  
option or modify the Job Buffer Size setting and fax jobs are currently stored on the  
hard disk option.  
You cannot format the hard disk option or change the Job Buffer Size while the hard  
disk option contains Print and Hold jobs or fax jobs.  
Press Go to continue. The request is ignored.  
Print Jobs on  
Disk? Go/Stop?  
This message displays when Print Job Buffering is enabled and the printer power is  
turned Off (O) while print jobs are spooled to the hard disk option. When the printer  
power is turned back On (|), it asks for confirmation to print the waiting jobs.  
Press Go to print the jobs.  
Press Return or Stop to delete all spooled jobs from the hard disk option without  
printing them.  
Chapter 6: Understanding Printer Messages  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Solving Printer  
Problems  
7
Sometimes printer problems are very easy to solve. When  
you have a problem, first make sure that:  
The printer power cord is plugged into the printer  
and a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
Note: If an error message dis-  
The printer power switch is On (| ).  
The electrical outlet is not turned off by any switch  
or breaker.  
Other electrical equipment plugged into the outlet  
is working.  
All options are properly installed.  
If you have checked all of the above and still have a prob-  
lem, turn the printer power Off (O), wait for about 10 sec-  
onds, and then turn the printer power On (| ). This often  
fixes the problem.  
Solving Printer Problems  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
The tables in this chapter define printing problems that  
may occur and what you can do to resolve them. If the  
suggested corrective action does not fix the problem, call  
your service representative.  
Turn to the appropriate page for help with your printing  
problem:  
Problem with...  
Display  
See page...  
Print Quality  
Printing  
Network  
Option  
Other Problems and Questions  
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Display Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Menus Disabled status message  
The operator panel menus are disabled. To enable the menus:  
appears on the display.  
Turn the printer power Off (O).  
Press and hold Select and Return, and then turn the printer power On (|).  
Release the buttons when Performing Self Test displays.  
Once the printer finishes powering on, the CONFIG MENU displays.  
Press Menu> until Panel Menus displays on the second line. Press Select.  
Press Menu> until Enable displays on the second line. Press Select.  
The Saved message briefly appears and then, the Enabling Menus displays.  
The CONFIG MENU displays again with Panel Menu on the second line.  
Press Menu> until Exit Config Menu displays on the second line. Press  
Select.  
Activating Menu Changes briefly appears, and then Performing Self Test  
briefly appears. The printer returns to the Ready state.  
If the operator panel menus are password protected, see your system adminis-  
trator.  
Display shows only diamonds or is  
blank.  
Turn the printer power Off (O), wait about 10 seconds, and turn the printer  
power On (|).  
The Performing Self Test message appears on the operator panel display.  
When the test is completed, the Ready message displays.  
If the messages do not display, turn the printer power Off (O) and call Lexmark  
Customer Support Center.  
Menu settings changed from the  
operator panel have no effect.  
Settings in the software application, the printer driver, or the printer utilities are  
overriding the settings in the operator panel.  
Change the menu settings from the printer driver, the printer utilities, or the  
software application instead of the operator panel.  
Disable the settings in the printer driver, the printer utilities, or the software  
application so you can change settings from the operator panel.  
Display Problems  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Printing Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Job did not print or incorrect  
characters printed.  
Make sure the Ready status message appears on the operator panel display  
before you send a job to print. Press Go to return the printer to the Ready status  
message.  
Make sure there is print material loaded in the printer. Press Go to return the  
printer to the Ready status message.  
Verify that the printer is using the correct printer language.  
Verify that the correct printer driver is being used.  
Make sure the parallel cable or USB cable is firmly plugged in at the back of  
the printer.  
Check the cable connection. Make sure you are using the correct cable. If  
you use the parallel port, we recommend a IEEE 1284-compliant parallel  
cable such as Lexmark part number 1329605 (10 ft) or 1427498 (20 ft). If  
you use the USB port, we recommend the cable with Lexmark part number  
12A2405 (2M).  
If the printer is connected through a switch box, try a direct connection.  
Verify that the correct paper size is selected through the operator panel, in  
the printer driver, or in the software application setting.  
Make sure PCL SmartSwitch and PS SmartSwitch are set to On.  
If a print spooler is used, verify that the spooler is not stalled.  
If you print across a network or on a Macintosh, see Network Printing  
Determine which host interface you are using. Print a menu settings page to  
verify that the current interface settings are correct. See Printing the Menu  
Settings Pageon page 39 for more information.  
If you are using serial interface:  
Make sure Honor DSR is set to Off.  
Check the protocol, baud, parity, and data bit settings. The settings on the  
printer and on the host computer should match.  
You are connected to the USB  
port, but the printer will not print.  
Make sure you are using Windows 98 or other USB-capable operating system  
supported by Lexmark.  
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Problem (continued)  
Action (continued)  
Print material misfeeds or multiple  
feeds occur.  
Make sure the print material you are using meets the specifications for your  
printer. See Print Material Guidelineson page 118 for more information.  
Flex print material before loading it in any of the paper sources.  
Make sure the print material is loaded correctly.  
Make sure the paper width and length guides on the paper sources are  
adjusted correctly and are not too tight.  
Do not overfill the paper sources.  
Do not force print material into the multipurpose feeder when you load it;  
otherwise, it may skew or buckle.  
Remove any curled print material from paper sources.  
If there is a recommended print side for the print material, load the print  
Load less print material in the input sources.  
Turn the print material over or around and try printing again to see if feeding  
improves.  
Do not mix print material types.  
Do not mix reams of print material.  
Remove the top and bottom sheets of a ream before loading the print  
material.  
Load an input source only when it is empty.  
You get unexpected page breaks. Check the Print Timeout setting in the SETUP MENU. Increase the setting. See  
Print Timeout on page 74 for more information.  
Job prints from the wrong input  
source or on the wrong print  
material.  
Check the PAPER TYPE setting in the PAPER MENU on the operator panel and  
in the printer driver. See PAPER TYPE on page 47 for more information.  
Print material does not stack  
neatly in an output bin.  
Turn the print material stack over in the tray or multipurpose feeder.  
If the print material is exiting to the standard output bin, make sure the paper  
bail is installed correctly. See Installing the Paper Bailon page 11 for more  
information.  
Printing Problems  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Print Quality  
Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Print is too light.  
Check the toner supply.  
Change the Toner Darkness setting in the QUALITY MENU. See Toner  
Darkness on page 71 for more information.  
If you are printing on an uneven print surface, change the PAPER WEIGHT  
and PAPER TEXTURE settings in the PAPER MENU. See PAPER TYPE on  
page 47 for more information.  
Verify that the correct print material is being used.  
Toner smears or print comes off  
the page.  
If you are printing on an uneven print surface, change the PAPER TEXTURE  
and PAPER WEIGHT settings in the PAPER MENU. See PAPER TEXTURE on  
page 50 and PAPER WEIGHT on page 51 for more information.  
Verify that the print material is within the printer specifications. See Using  
Print Materialson page 115 for more information.  
If the problem continues, call Lexmark Customer Support Center.  
Toner appears on the back of the  
printed page.  
Toner is on the transfer roll. To help prevent this, do not load print material that  
is smaller than the page size of the job to be printed.  
Open and close the printer upper front door to run the printer through its  
setup cycle and clean the transfer roll.  
Replace the fuser cleaner. The fuser cleaner and replacement instructions  
are included in the box when you purchase a new print cartridge.  
Toner fog or background shading  
appears on the page.  
Check the print cartridge to make sure it is installed correctly. See Installing  
the Print Cartridgeon page 5 for more information.  
Change the print cartridge. See Maintaining Your Printeron page 193 for  
more information.  
If the problem continues, change the charge roll. See Ordering a  
Charge Roll Kiton page 195 for more information.  
Entire page is white.  
Make sure the packaging material is removed from the print cartridge. See  
Check the print cartridge to be sure it is installed correctly. See Installing the  
Print Cartridgeon page 5 for more information.  
Check the toner supply.  
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
Problem (continued)  
Action (continued)  
Streaks appear on the page.  
The toner may be low. Remove the cartridge. To utilize the remaining toner,  
shake the cartridge gently. Reinstall the same print cartridge. See Installing  
If you are using preprinted forms, make sure the ink can withstand  
temperatures of 200°C (392°F).  
The printhead lens may need cleaning. See Cleaning the Printhead Lens”  
on page 195 for directions.  
Printing is too dark.  
Change the Toner Darkness setting in the QUALITY MENU. See Toner  
Darkness on page 71 for more information.  
Note: Macintosh users should make sure the lines per inch (lpi) setting is not  
set too high in the software application.  
Characters have jagged or uneven  
edges.  
Change the Print Resolution setting in the QUALITY MENU to 600 dpi. See  
Print Resolution on page 71 for more information.  
Turn PQET in the QUALITY MENU to On. See PQET on page 72 for more  
information.  
If you are using downloaded fonts, verify that the fonts are supported by the  
printer, the host computer, and the software application.  
Image quality is poor.  
Resolution was automatically reduced. Reduce the complexity of the print job  
or add additional printer memory. See Res Reduced on page 157 for more  
information.  
Part of all of the page is printed in  
black.  
Check the print cartridge to see if it is installed correctly. See Installing the  
Print Cartridgeon page 5 for more information.  
If the charge roll has been replaced, verify that it has been installed correctly.  
Refer to the installation instructions that come with the charge roll kit. See  
The job prints, but the left and top  
margins are incorrect.  
Make sure the PAPER SIZE setting is set correctly in the PAPER MENU. See  
PAPER SIZE on page 45 for more information.  
Make sure the margins are set correctly in the software application you are  
using.  
Check the Print Area setting in the SETUP MENU. Set the value to Normal.  
See Print Area on page 76 for more information.  
Print Quality Problems  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Option Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Option does not operate correctly  
after it is installed or it quits  
working.  
Turn the printer power Off (O), wait for about 10 seconds, and turn the printer  
power On (|). If this does not fix the problem, unplug the printer, and check  
the connection between the option and printer.  
Print the menu settings page and check to see if the option is listed in the  
Installed Options list. If the option is not listed, reinstall it. See Verifying the  
Make sure the option is selected in the software application you are using.  
For Macintosh users: Make sure the printer is set up in CHOOSER.  
Option does not operate correctly Optional Drawer: Make sure the connection between the optional 500-sheet  
after it is installed.  
drawer and the printer is secure. See Optional 500-Sheet Draweron  
page 223 for more information.  
Make sure the print material is loaded correctly. See Loading Print Materialon  
page 124 for more information.  
Flash Memory Option: Check to make sure the flash memory option is  
securely connected to the printer system board. See Understanding Memory  
Optionson page 206 for more information.  
Printer Memory Option: Check to make sure the printer memory option is  
securely connected to the printer system board. See Understanding Memory  
Optionson page 206 for more information.  
Hard Disk Option: Check to make sure the hard disk option is securely  
connected to the printer system board. See Hard Disk Optionon page 212 for  
more information.  
Hard Disk Adapter Card: Check to make sure the hard disk option is securely  
connected to the hard disk adapter card. Also check to make sure the hard disk  
adapter card is securely connected to the printer system board. See Hard Disk  
Optionon page 212 for more information.  
Internal Print Server Option: Check to make sure the optional internal print  
server (also called an internal network adapter or INA) is securely connected to  
or INA)on page 211 for more information.  
The connection to the network is made through the network cable. Check that  
you have the correct cable, that it is securely connected, and that the network  
software is correctly set up. See the documentation that comes with your  
optional internal print server for more information.  
Tri-Port Interface Option: Check to make sure the Tri-Port Interface option  
card is securely connected to the printer system board. See Tri-Por t Interface  
Option Cardon page 212 for more information.  
For Macintosh users: Make sure the host computer is set to LocalTalk.  
If you are using a phone wire connection, a terminator plug must be used.  
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Problem (continued)  
Action (continued)  
Option does not operate correctly Infrared Adapter: If infrared communication stops or does not occur, check the  
after it is installed.  
(continued)  
following:  
Communication distance: The distance between the two infrared ports  
should be 3 meters (10 ft.) or less. If communication does not occur between  
ports, move the ports closer together.  
Make sure both ports are stable. Make sure the computer is on a level  
surface.  
Make sure the angle of communication between the two infrared ports is  
within 15 degrees of either side of an imaginary line drawn between the two  
infrared ports.  
Make sure there is no bright light, such as direct sunshine, interfering with  
communication.  
Make sure no objects are placed between the two infrared ports.  
Parallel/USB Interface Option: Check to make sure the parallel/USB interface  
option card is securely connected to the printer system board. See  
Network Printing  
Problems  
Problem  
Action  
Job did not print or incorrect  
characters printed.  
If you are using a Lexmark internal print server or external print server, verify  
that it is set up properly and the network cable is connected.  
Note: Refer to the documentation that comes with your print server for more  
information.  
For Novell users:  
Make sure the netware.drv file is dated October 24, 1994 or later.  
Make sure the NT (no tabs) flag is included in the capture statement.  
For Macintosh users:  
The printer may need an optional internal print server to allow Macintosh  
connection.  
Verify that the printer is set up correctly in CHOOSER.  
Network Printing Problems  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Other Problems  
and Questions  
Problem  
Action  
How do I get updated printer  
drivers or utilities?  
See Introducing MarkVisionon page 25 for more information.  
How do I attach a serial cable to  
the printer?  
Your printer requires an optional adapter to allow serial attachment. The Tri-Port  
interface option card supports serial RS-232C/RS-422A. See Tri-Port Interface  
Option Cardon page 212 for more information.  
Where are the printer escape  
codes listed?  
The CD that was shipped with your printer contains an Adobe Acrobat file with  
a complete list of Printer Command Language (PCL) escape codes.  
Chapter 7: Solving Printer Problems  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Clearing Jams  
8
By carefully selecting print materials and loading them  
properly, you should be able to avoid most paper jams. If  
paper jams do occur, complete the steps in the following  
sections. If paper jams occur frequently, make sure you see  
To clear paper jam attendance messages, you must remove  
all jammed print material from the paper path.  
Press Go to resume printing. If Jam Recovery is set to On or  
Auto, the printer prints a new copy of the page that  
jammed. However, the Auto setting does not guarantee the  
page will print.  
Refer to the appropriate page for help with clearing paper  
jams.  
If the following error message displays...  
200 Paper Jam - Remove Print Cartridge  
201 Paper Jam - Remove Print Cartridge  
202 Paper Jam - Open Rear Door  
See page...  
203 Paper Jam - Short Paper  
250 Paper Jam - Check MP Feeder  
Clearing Jams  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Possible Paper The following illustration shows the path that print mate-  
rial travels through the printer. The path varies depending  
on the input source and exit selection (output bin). The  
jam areas are also shown.  
Jam Areas  
203 Paper Jam  
201 Paper Jam  
200 Paper Jam  
202 Paper Jam  
250 Paper Jam  
200 and 201 Paper  
Jam - Remove  
Cartridge  
Print material is jammed in the area under the print  
cartridge. This requires removing the print cartridge from  
the printer. With a 201 attendance message, the jam is far-  
ther back in the printer, so you need to reach in farther to  
remove the jammed print material.  
Note: To clear paper jam  
attendance messages, you must  
remove all jammed print material  
from the paper path.  
1 Open the upper front door.  
2 Remove the print cartridge.  
See page 2 for instructions on removing the print  
cartridge.  
Caution! The rear portion of  
the inside of the printer may be  
hot.  
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
3 Notice that in some instances the ends of the print  
material are not visible.  
4 Gently pull the right side of the print material  
until the upper right corner is loose.  
5 With both hands, pull the print material up to the  
right and then out.  
6 Reinstall the print cartridge. (See page 5 for  
instructions on reinstalling the print cartridge.)  
7 Close the upper front door.  
Note: If there is resistance to  
the print material, and it does  
not move immediately when you  
pull it, stop pulling and access  
the print material from the rear  
output bin door. See 202 Paper  
page 186 for more information.  
Possible Paper Jam Areas  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
202 Paper Jam -  
Open Rear Door  
Jams in the following areas cause a 202 attendance mes-  
sage. Jams in these areas require opening the printer rear  
output bin door and the upper front door:  
The print material jams before reaching the  
standard output bin. See Before Reaching the Stan-  
dard Output Binas follows.  
The print material jams after it starts into the  
standard output bin, but before it exits completely  
Note: To clear paper jam  
Before Reaching the Standard Output Bin  
attendance messages, you must  
remove all jammed print material  
from the paper path.  
The print material jams before reaching the standard  
output bin.  
1 Locate the handhold on the rear output bin door  
and pull it toward you.  
The rear output bin door opens and drops back  
toward you. If you need help, see Using the  
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
2 Determine how to remove the jammed print  
material based on what part of the print material is  
visible.  
If the middle of the sheet of print material is  
visible, but not the ends, grasp the print material  
on both sides and gently pull it straight out  
toward you.  
Note: If print material is still in  
the fuser area, open the upper  
front door to release the fuser  
rollers to free the print material.  
Possible Paper Jam Areas  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If an end of the print material is visible, pull the  
print material straight out toward you.  
Note: To avoid tearing, pull the  
jammed print material out gently  
and slowly.  
3 Close the rear output bin door.  
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Note: To clear paper jam  
attendance messages, you must  
remove all jammed print material  
from the paper path.  
Exiting to the Standard Output Bin  
Print material jams before it exits completely into the  
standard output bin.  
1 Pull the print material straight out. If there is resis-  
tance to the print material and it does not move  
immediately when you pull, stop pulling and con-  
tinue with the next step.  
2 Open the upper front door to release the fuser  
rollers.  
3 Pull the print material straight out.  
Note: To avoid tearing, pull the  
jammed print material out gently  
and slowly.  
Possible Paper Jam Areas  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
203 Paper Jam -  
Short Paper  
A 203 attendance message indicates print material less  
than 152.4 mm (6 in.) in length has attempted to exit the  
standard output bin.  
A jam in this area requires that the rear output bin door be  
opened.  
Note: To clear paper jam  
attendance messages, you must  
remove all jammed print material  
from the paper path.  
1 Locate the handhold on the rear output bin door  
and pull it toward you.  
The rear output bin door opens and drops back  
toward you. If you need help, see Using the  
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
2 Remove the print material.  
If there is resistance to the print material and it does  
not move immediately when you pull, stop pulling.  
Remove the print cartridge, return to the back of the  
printer, and pull the print material out.  
Note: If you cannot find the  
jammed print material inside the  
printer, check to see if the print  
job has exited the standard out-  
put bin.  
3 Leave the rear output bin door open to allow the  
job to finish printing.  
4 Press Go to resume printing.  
5 If you are going to print additional pages less than  
152.4 mm (6 in.) in length, set Paper Length to Short.  
Possible Paper Jam Areas  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
250 Paper Jam -  
Check MP Feeder  
The print material jams as it enters the printer from the  
multipurpose feeder.  
Pull the jammed print material straight out of the multi-  
purpose feeder toward you.  
To avoid tearing, pull the jammed print material out gen-  
tly and slowly.  
Note: To clear paper jam  
attendance messages, you must  
remove all jammed print material  
from the paper path.  
Chapter 8: Clearing Jams  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Maintaining  
Your Printer  
9
Note: If you are in the U.S. or  
Canada, call 1-800-438-2468 for  
information about Lexmark  
Authorized Supplies Dealers in  
your area. In other countries,  
contact the place where you  
bought your printer.  
Periodically, you will need to replace the print cartridge  
and clean the printer to maintain optimum print quality.  
If several people are using the printer, you may want to  
designate a key operator to do the setup and maintenance  
of your printer. Refer printing problems and maintenance  
tasks to this key operator.  
Ordering a Print You need to have a new print cartridge available when the  
current one no longer prints satisfactorily. There are two  
recommended print cartridges specifically designed for  
your printer:  
Cartridge  
Printer Model Part Number  
Yield (Average) Coverage  
Optra M410 or 17G0152  
M412  
5,000 pages  
5%  
Optra M410 or 17G0154  
M412  
15,000 pages  
5%  
Ordering a Print Cartridge  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Storing the Print Store the print cartridge in the original packaging until  
you are ready to install it.  
Cartridge  
Do not store the print cartridge in:  
Temperatures greater than 40°C (104°F).  
An environment with extreme changes in humidity  
or temperature.  
Direct sunlight.  
Dusty places.  
A car for a long period of time.  
An environment where corrosive gases are present.  
An environment with salty air.  
Replacing the Complete the following steps to replace the print  
cartridge. Refer to the documentation that comes with the  
print cartridge for detailed installation information.  
Print Cartridge  
Warning! Do not refill used  
1 Remove the used print cartridge.  
2 Clean the printer.  
print cartridges or purchase a  
refilled cartridge. The print car-  
tridge warranty is voided by  
unauthorized refilling.  
3 Install the new print cartridge.  
4 Replace the fuser cleaner.  
Use the installation instructions that come in the  
box with your new print cartridge to complete steps  
2 through 4.  
5 Follow the instructions on the new print cartridge  
box to recycle the used print cartridge.  
When you return a used print cartridge, you contribute to  
a worldwide recycling effort at no cost to you.  
For best results, use Lexmark supplies with the printer.  
Chapter 9: Maintaining Your Printer  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
Cleaning the Complete the following steps to clean the printhead lens:  
Printhead Lens  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).  
2 Open the upper and lower front doors.  
3 Remove the print cartridge.  
4 Gently wipe the printhead lens with a clean, dry  
lint-free cloth.  
Printhead Lens  
5 Insert the print cartridge.  
6 Close the upper and lower front doors.  
7 Turn the printer power On (| ).  
Ordering a We recommend you order a new charge roll kit when  
toner fog or background shading appears on printed  
Charge Roll Kit  
information on toner fog and background shading.  
Order Lexmark part number 4K00196. Installation instruc-  
tions are included in the kit.  
If youre in the U.S. or Canada, call 1-800-438-2468 for  
information about Lexmark Authorized Supplies Dealers  
in your area. In other countries, contact the place where  
you bought your printer.  
Cleaning the Printhead Lens  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Chapter 9: Maintaining Your Printer  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fax  
10  
Understanding the If your printer has a Tri-Port interface option card  
installed and the serial interface port is not in use, you can  
Fax Port  
use your printer to receive and print fax data.  
The serial interface port is only available if a Tri-Port inter-  
face option card is installed in your printer. See Tri-Port  
When you want to use the fax serial port for another pur-  
pose, you must first follow the instructions for disabling  
the fax port on page 200. If you decide to reactivate the fax  
port, make sure you follow the instructions for setting up  
the fax port on page 198.  
Note: Never attempt to config-  
ure your serial port for multiple  
uses with an A-B switch.  
Choosing To use your printer serial port to process fax data, you  
need an external, class 1 fax modem. You can use virtually  
any brand, as long as it is a class 1 fax modem.  
Hardware  
Understanding the Fax Port  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Setting Up a To use your printer serial port to process fax data:  
Fax Port  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O) and unplug the  
printer power cord.  
2 Turn the modem power Off and unplug the  
Printer  
modem power cord.  
Serial  
Port  
Power Cord  
3 Disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
Modem  
Cable  
4 Connect the hardware. The end of the modem cable  
that connects to the serial port must be 25-pin.  
External  
Class 1  
Fax  
Phone  
Cord  
The class 1 fax modem connects to the serial port of  
your printer. If you need additional help, refer to the  
class 1 fax modem documentation for details.  
Modem  
Note: It is very important to  
power on the modem before you  
power on the printer.  
5 Reconnect all cables to the back of the printer.  
6 Reconnect the power cords to the printer and the  
modem to properly grounded electrical outlets.  
7 Turn the modem power On.  
8 Turn the printer power On (| ).  
9 Once Ready displays, complete the following steps  
to configure the serial port for fax data:  
identify the display and operator  
panel buttons if you need help.  
a Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.  
b Press Menu> until FAX MENU appears on the first  
line of the display.  
c Press Select.  
Fax Port appears on the second line of the display.  
d Press Select to choose Fax Port.  
Chapter 10: Fax  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Note: If an error message  
appears, see Understanding  
e Press Menu> until Ser Option 1 appears on the  
second line of the display.  
f
Press Select to choose Ser Option 1.  
g Fax Port appears on the second line. Press Go.  
Activating Menu Changes appears and remains on  
the display until the serial port is reset.  
See Fax Menuon page 102 for more information.  
Resetting a If power to the modem is interrupted you must complete  
the following steps, in order, for your printer to process fax  
data:  
Fax Port  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).  
2 Turn the modem power On.  
3 Turn the printer power On (| ).  
Resetting a Fax Port  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Disabling a To disable the fax port and restore the printer serial port  
settings:  
Fax Port  
1 When Ready displays on the top line of the opera-  
tor panel display, press Menu> or <Menu to enter the  
menus.  
2 Continue to press Menu> or <Menu until FAX MENU  
appears on the first line of the display.  
3 Press Select.  
Fax Port appears on the second line of the display.  
4 Press Select to choose Fax Port.  
5 Press Menu> until Disabled appears on the second  
line of the display.  
Serial Option 1 displays on the second line of the dis-  
play.  
6 Press Select to disable the fax port.  
7 Press Go.  
Activating Menu Changes appears and remains on the  
display until the printer restores the serial port  
settings.  
Note: If an error message  
appears, see Understanding  
8 Turn the modem power Off.  
9 Turn the printer power Off (O).  
10 Disconnect all system components from the  
modem.  
11 Disconnect the modem cable from the printer  
serial port.  
12 Turn the printer power On (| ).  
See Fax Menuon page 102 for more information.  
Chapter 10: Fax  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Memory and  
Option Cards  
11  
Note: You need a small Phil-  
lips screwdriver to complete the  
installation of some options.  
You can customize your printer memory capacity and con-  
nectivity. This chapter provides instructions for installing  
and removing each option. To install each option, you  
must first access the printer system board. This can be  
done from the left side of the printer.  
Accessing the Complete the following steps before installing printer  
memory, a flash memory option, or an option card.  
Printer System  
Board  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O) and unplug the  
printer power cord from the electrical outlet.  
Caution! To avoid electrical  
2 Disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
shock hazards, make sure your  
computer power is Off (O) and  
unplug all computer equipment  
before connecting cables.  
Accessing the Printer System Board  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
3 Push the upper release latch to release the upper  
front door.  
4 Push the lower release latch to release the lower  
front door.  
5 Press the latches located inside the front of the  
printer to release the side door.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6 Remove the side door and lay it aside.  
7 Loosen the six screws on the shield. Do not  
Screws  
remove the screws.  
Screws  
Accessing the Printer System Board  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8 Use the tabs located on the side of the shield to  
slide the shield up until the top three screws fit  
into the three keyholes on the shield.  
Keyhole  
9 Hold the shield by the tabs and lift it off.  
Tabs  
10 Locate the appropriate connector for the option  
Memory  
Connector 1  
Memory  
Connector 2  
you are installing.  
Option Card Connector  
Note: Both memory connec-  
tor 1 and memory connector 2  
are capable of accepting either a  
printer memory option or a flash  
memory option card.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11 See the appropriate section for instructions on  
installing the option.  
For a printer memory or flash memory option,  
For an optional internal print server (also called  
an internal network adapter or INA), see  
For a Tri-Port interface option card, see Tri-Port  
For a hard disk option, see Hard Disk Option”  
For a Parallel/ USB interface option card, see  
Accessing the Printer System Board  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Understanding Because the steps required to install a printer memory  
option and a flash memory option card are the same, they  
are grouped together in this section. Details about the two  
option cards follow.  
Memory Options  
Printer Memory  
The printer memory option increases the printer sync  
dynamic random access memory (SDRAM). Additional  
printer memory allows the printer to print complex jobs  
and operate more efficiently.  
Your printer has 4MB of standard printer memory. You  
can purchase printer memory cards having 4MB, 8MB,  
16MB, 32MB, and 64MB of memory. You can install up to  
two optional printer memory cards in your printer, for a  
total of up to 132MB of SDRAM.  
Warning! Data stored in printer  
memory is lost when the printer  
is unplugged.  
Flash Memory  
The flash memory option is useful for storing information  
such as downloaded fonts, macros, symbol sets, logos,  
and forms. Use your printer driver or the MarkVision  
utility to download resources to flash memory.  
You can install one flash memory option in your printer.  
Flash memory options available are 2, 4, 8, and 16MB.  
Note: Data stored in flash  
memory is retained when the  
printer is unplugged.  
See page 212 for instructions on installing the hard disk  
option, which provides memory storage similar to the  
flash memory option.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Installing This section offers instructions for installing either a  
printer memory option or a flash memory option card.  
You may install any one of the following memory configu-  
rations on your printer system board:  
Memory Options  
One printer memory option.  
One flash memory option.  
One printer memory option and one flash memory  
option.  
Two printer memory options.  
Before installing any option card, you must remove the  
printer system board cover.  
Warning! Printer memory and  
flash memory option cards are  
easily damaged by static elec-  
tricity. Touch something metal  
before you touch an option card.  
2 Locate the two memory connectors on the system  
Memory Connector 1  
Memory Connector 2  
board.  
Both memory connector 1 and memory connector 2  
are capable of accepting either a printer memory  
option or a flash memory option card.  
3 Follow the steps under Removing  
remove an option card before you install a new  
one. Otherwise, go to step 4.  
Installing Memory Options  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
4 Unpack the new option card.  
Connection Points  
Avoid touching the connection points along the  
edge of the card. Save the packaging.  
Warning! Printer memory  
option and flash memory option  
cards are easily damaged by  
static electricity. Touch some-  
thing metal before you touch an  
option card.  
5 Hold the option card with the connection points  
Connection Points  
pointing toward the system board as shown.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
6 Insert the option card straight into the connector  
as shown.  
Make sure the edges of the card fit into the slots  
located on each of the connector latches.  
Note: This illustration is for the  
Optra M410. The connector for  
the Optra M412 is inverted.  
Invert the option card to insert it.  
7 Push in on one side of the card and push in one of  
the latches until it snaps into place. Repeat for the  
other side of the card.  
Latch  
Make sure each latch fits over the notch located on  
either side of the option card.  
8 Repeat steps 4 through 7 to install another mem-  
ory option card in one of the memory connectors.  
Otherwise, go to step 9.  
Notch  
page 216 if you have other option cards to install.  
Installing Memory Options  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Removing Before removing a memory option, follow the steps under  
Memory Options  
To remove a printer memory option or a flash memory  
option card:  
Warning! Printer memory  
option and flash memory option  
cards are easily damaged by  
static electricity. Touch some-  
thing metal before you touch an  
option card.  
1 Locate the option card that you want to remove.  
2 Push the latches at each end of the memory con-  
nector away from the option card.  
3 Pull the option card straight out of the memory  
connector.  
4 Place the option card in its original packaging.  
If you did not save the packaging, wrap the option  
card in paper and store it in a box.  
5 Follow the steps under Installing Memory  
Optionson page 207 if you need to install a new  
printer memory option or flash memory option  
card. Otherwise, go to step 6.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Understanding Four kinds of option cards are available for your printer:  
Option Cards  
Internal print server option card  
Tri-Port interface option card  
Hard disk option  
Parallel/ USB interface option card  
Refer to the documentation that is included with each  
option card for detailed information about that specific  
card.  
Note: Only one option card  
can be installed in your printer at  
a time.  
The installation instructions are the same for each type of  
option card; therefore, they are grouped together. Installa-  
tion instructions begin on page 216.  
Internal Print Server  
(Internal Network  
Adapter or INA)  
An optional internal print server lets you connect your  
printer to a local area network (LAN). You can install one  
print server in your printer. There are MarkNetTM cards  
available to support the following topologies:  
Ethernet (100BaseTX, 10BaseT, 10Base2)  
Token-Ring (DB9 or RJ45)  
Internal print servers have a similar size and shape. Make  
sure the network port on the card corresponds to your net-  
work cable requirements. Refer to the documentation that  
came with the print server for more information.  
Network Port  
Installing the Optional Internal Print Server  
To install, complete the following two sections in order:  
Card Connector Points  
Understanding Option Cards  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Tri-Port Interface  
Option Card  
The Tri-Port interface option card lets you connect to:  
A LocalTalk network  
Serial interface (RS-232C or Serial RS-422A)  
An infrared adapter  
For information about the LocalTalk network, see Local-  
LocalTalk Port  
Serial Port  
For more information about serial interface, see Serial  
An infrared adapter receives an infrared beam that allows  
you to print remotely to an IrDA-compatible computer.  
For more information, see Infrared Menuon page 93.  
Installing the Tri-Port Interface Option Card  
Infrared Port  
Card Connector Points  
To install, complete the following two sections in order:  
Hard Disk Option  
Like the flash memory option, the hard disk option is use-  
ful for storing information such as downloaded fonts,  
macros, and symbol sets.  
You can also use the hard disk option to store incoming  
print jobs in a buffer until they print. Since hard disk  
memory provides permanent storage, job buffering to the  
hard disk prevents the loss of print job data if the printer  
loses power. It may also free your application faster for  
other work. Job buffering is only available for jobs trans-  
mitted across the standard parallel and USB interface.  
Note: Data stored on the hard  
disk option is kept in memory  
when the printer is turned off.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
                 
You can purchase:  
A hard disk with an adapter card already installed.  
A hard disk that supports Optra FormsTM with an  
adapter card already installed. Refer to Optra Forms  
for more information.  
A hard disk adapter card for installing a separately  
purchased hard disk.  
Complete the following instructions to attach the hard  
disk to the adapter card. If your disk is already attached to  
Attaching a Hard Disk to the Adapter Card  
You can use the adapter card with any hard disk meeting  
the following criteria:  
2.5-inch platter  
ATA-2 (IDE) interface  
Maximum thickness of 15 mm (.59 in.)  
To attach the hard disk to the adapter card:  
Adapter Card  
1 Align the connector pins on the end of the hard  
disk with the connector on the back of the adapter  
card.  
Hard Disk  
Understanding Option Cards  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
2 Push the hard disk securely into the connector.  
3 Turn the adapter card over and insert the four  
screws. Securely tighten each screw.  
Installing the Hard Disk Option Card  
To install, complete the following two sections in order:  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parallel/USB  
Interface  
Option Card  
The parallel/ USB interface option card lets you connect  
your printer to a parallel interface. You can also use the  
USB (Universal Serial Bus) port to connect your printer to  
a computer. For more information about USB, see USB  
Installing the Parallel/USB Interface Option Card  
To install, complete the following two sections in order:  
USB Port  
Parallel Port  
Card Connector Points  
Understanding Option Cards  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Installing an Before installing an option card, follow the steps under  
Option Card  
To install a hard disk option card, optional internal print  
server, Tri-Port interface option card, or parallel/ USB  
interface option card:  
Warning! The option card is  
easily damaged by static elec-  
tricity. Touch something metal  
before you touch the card.  
1 Locate the option card connector on the printer  
system board.  
2 Follow the steps under Removing an Option  
Cardon page 219 if you need to remove an option  
card before installing another one. Otherwise, go  
to step 3.  
Option Card Connector  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
3 Remove the metal plate covering the connector  
slot.  
a Locate the two screws on the back of the printer  
that attach the metal plate to the slot.  
b Remove and save the two screws. Remove and  
discard the plate.  
4 Unpack the option card.  
Save the packing materials.  
Faceplate Opening  
5 Align the connector on the option card with the  
connector on the system board.  
The cable connectors on the side of the option card  
must fit through the opening in the faceplate.  
6 Push the option card firmly into the option card  
connector on the system board.  
Option Card Connector  
Installing an Option Card  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
7 Insert the two screws saved from the metal plate  
(or the extra screws shipped with the option card)  
into the holes on either side of the connector slot.  
8 Gently tighten the screws to secure the card to the  
system board.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removing an Before removing an option card, follow the steps under  
Option Card  
To remove an option card:  
Warning! The option card is  
easily damaged by static elec-  
tricity. Touch something metal  
before you touch the card.  
1 Remove the two screws on either side of the con-  
nector slot located on the back of the printer.  
2 Pull the option card straight out of the system  
board connector.  
3 Place the option card in its original packaging.  
If you did not save the packaging, wrap the card in  
paper and store it in a box.  
4 Follow the steps under Installing an  
Option Cardon page 216 if you need to install an  
option card. Otherwise, go to step 5.  
Removing an Option Card  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
Closing the Printer After you have installed all of your options on the printer  
system board, reattach the shield and close the side door:  
System Board  
1 Grasp the shield by the tabs and align the three  
keyholes on the shield with the top three screws  
on the side of the printer.  
2 Holding the shield by the tabs, slide it down.  
3 Tighten all six screws.  
Tabs  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
4 Hold the side door slightly to the left of the printer  
and place the latches located on the back edge of  
the side door against the metal shield.  
The edge of the metal shield fits into the latches. The  
top latch fits inside the back of the printer.  
5 Close the side door, pressing on the side door  
latches to snap it into place.  
6 Close the upper and lower front doors.  
7 Reconnect all cables to the back of the printer.  
8 Reconnect the printer power cord to the printer  
and a properly grounded electrical outlet.  
9 Turn the printer power On (| ).  
10 Make sure the Ready message appears on the oper-  
ator panel display.  
If an error message appears, see Understanding  
Note: To verify options are  
installed properly, see Verifying  
Closing the Printer System Board  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Chapter 11: Memory and Option Cards  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Optional  
500-Sheet  
Drawer  
12  
Decide on a location to set the support unit. The printer will  
be placed on top of it, so allow enough space for easy paper  
access. The location must be sturdy and large enough to  
accommodate the printer and the optional 500-sheet  
drawer.  
Installing the The optional drawer consists of a support unit and an  
input tray. To install the optional 500-sheet drawer:  
Optional Drawer  
1 Turn the printer power Off (O).  
2 Unplug the printer power cord.  
3 Disconnect all cables from the back of the printer.  
Caution! To avoid electrical  
shock hazards, make sure your  
computer power is Off (O) and  
unplug all computer equipment  
before connecting cables.  
4 Remove the support unit from its packaging.  
Remove any packing tape.  
Installing the Optional Drawer  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
5 Pull the input tray out of the support unit.  
Remove any packing material and tape from the  
input tray.  
6 Grasp the support unit on each side at opposite  
corners and move it to the location being used.  
7 Notice the following parts located on the top sur-  
face of the optional support unit: the tab, the  
round hole, and the four square holes.  
Square Holes  
Tab  
8 Lift the printer by the handholds or ask someone  
to help you lift the printer.  
The bottom surface of the printer has matching  
holes or feet that accommodate the tab, round hole,  
and four square holes.  
Square Holes  
Round Hole  
Caution! Make sure your fin-  
gers are not under the printer  
when you set it down.  
Chapter 12: Optional 500-Sheet Drawer  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
9 Place the printer on top of the support unit.  
Make sure the edges of the printer and the support  
unit are aligned properly.  
10 Load print material in the input tray.  
information.  
11 Install the input tray in the support unit.  
12 Reconnect all cables to the back of the printer.  
13 Plug the printer power cord into a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
14 Turn the printer power On (| ).  
15 When Ready displays, press Menu> to enter the  
menus.  
Note: Verify that the optional  
drawer is installed properly. See  
16 Set the PAPER SIZE, PAPER TYPE, and PAPER  
LENGTH menu settings for this paper source.  
See PAPER SIZE on page 45, PAPER TYPE on page 47,  
and PAPER LENGTH on page 52 for more informa-  
tion.  
17 Press Go to return to the Ready state.  
If an error message appears, see Understanding  
Installing the Optional Drawer  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Chapter 12: Optional 500-Sheet Drawer  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infrared  
Adapter  
13  
You can use an infrared adapter to print remotely to an  
IrDA-compatible computer equipped with an infrared  
port.  
The Tri-Port interface option card, which includes an  
infrared port, lets you connect the infrared adapter to your  
printer. For more information, see Tri-Port Interface  
Option Cardon page 212. If you need to install the Tri-  
Port interface option card, see Installing an Option Card”  
After you install the Tri-Port interface option card, com-  
plete the following steps to connect the infrared adapter to  
your printer.  
Connecting the To connect the infrared adapter to your printer:  
Cable and Using  
1 Unplug the printer power cord.  
the Infrared  
2 Locate the infrared port on the back of your  
Adapter  
printer.  
The infrared port is attached to the Tri-Port interface  
option card installed in your printer.  
Connecting the Cable and Using the Infrared Adapter  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
3 Plug the adapter cable into the infrared port.  
4 Reconnect the printer power cord to a properly  
grounded electrical outlet.  
If any light on the infrared adapter comes on when  
the printer is plugged in, the adapter is connected to  
the port correctly.  
5 Aim the computer infrared port at the infrared  
port on the front of the Tri-Port interface option  
card.  
Adapter  
Cable  
Refer to the documentation that came with your  
computer for information about your computer  
infrared port.  
Infrared  
Port  
6 Draw an imaginary line between the two infrared  
ports. Aim the infrared port on your computer  
within 15 degrees of either side of this line, as  
shown.  
7 Send a job to print.  
If the job does not print correctly, see Infrared Adapter  
Chapter 13: Infrared Adapter  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Verifying the  
Installation of  
Options  
14  
You can verify that printer options are properly installed  
by printing a menu settings page.  
A menu settings page lists:  
All printer settings in the operator panel menus and  
their default values.  
All installed features and options, such as the  
optional 500-sheet drawer, internal print server  
(also called an internal network adapter or INA),  
flash memory option, printer memory option, and  
hard disk option.  
Amount of available printer memory.  
Other printer settings.  
Printing the Menu Before printing the menu settings page, make sure the  
selected paper source holds letter-, legal-, or A4-size  
paper, the PAPER SIZE setting is set to the correct size, and  
Settings Page  
the PAPER TYPE setting for the paper source is Plain Paper.  
Printing the Menu Settings Page  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
To print a menu settings page:  
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the  
Ready status message appears on the display.  
page 34 to identify the display and operator panel  
buttons.  
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.  
3 Continue to press and release Menu> or <Menu until  
you see UTILITIES MENU.  
4 Press Select.  
5 Press Menu> until Print Menus appears on the sec-  
ond line of the display.  
6 Press Select.  
The message Printing Menu Settings appears and  
remains on the operator panel display until the  
page prints. The printer returns to the Ready state  
after the menu settings page prints.  
If an error message appears, see Understanding  
7 Check to see if the option you installed is listed.  
All installed options are listed on the menu settings  
page under Installed Features.  
If an installed option does not appear on the page, it  
is not installed correctly or aligned properly. Turn  
the printer power Off (O), unplug the printer power  
cord, reinstall the option, and print the menu set-  
tings page again.  
Chapter 14: Verifying the Installation of Options  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Understanding  
Fonts  
A
This appendix contains basic information about fonts,  
their characteristics, and the specific fonts available in  
PCL 6 and PostScript 3 emulations.  
Typefaces A font is a set of characters and symbols created with a dis-  
tinct design. The distinct design is called a typeface. The  
typefaces you select add personality to a document.  
Well-chosen typefaces make a document easier to read.  
and Fonts  
The printer has numerous resident fonts in PCL 6 and  
PostScript 3 emulations. See Resident Fontson page 235  
for a listing of all resident fonts.  
Weight and Style  
Typefaces are often available in different weights and  
styles. These variations modify the original typeface so  
you can, for example, emphasize important words in text  
or highlight book titles. The different weights and styles  
are designed to complement the original typeface.  
Weight refers to the thickness of the lines that form the  
characters. Thicker lines result in darker characters. Some  
words commonly used to describe the weight of a type-  
face are bold, medium, light, black and heavy.  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
Style refers to other typeface modifications, such as tilt or  
character width. Italic and oblique are styles where the  
characters are tilted. Narrow, condensed and extended are  
three common styles that modify the character widths.  
Some fonts combine several weight and style modifica-  
tions; for example, Helvetica Narrow Bold Italic. A group  
of several weight and style variations of a single typeface  
is called a typeface family. Most typeface families have four  
variations: regular, italic, bold, and bold italic. Some fami-  
lies have more variations, as the following illustration for  
the Helvetica typeface family shows:  
Pitch and Point Size  
The size of a font is specified as either a pitch or point size,  
depending on whether the font is fixed space or propor-  
tional.  
In fixed space fonts, each character has the same width.  
Pitch is used to specify the size of fixed space fonts. It is a  
measure of the number of characters that will print in one  
horizontal inch of type. For example, all 10-pitch fonts  
print 10 characters per inch (cpi) and all 12-pitch fonts  
print 12 cpi:  
Courier  
Courier-Bold  
10 Pitch 1234567890  
10 Pitch 1234567890  
Courier  
Courier-Bold  
12 Pitch  
12 Pitch  
123456789012  
123456789012  
1 inch  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
In proportional (or typographic) fonts, every character can  
have a different width. Since proportional fonts have char-  
acters with different widths, the font size is specified in  
point size, not pitch. Point size refers to the height of the  
characters in the font. A point is defined as 1/ 72 inch. The  
characters in a font printed at 24 point will be twice as  
large as the characters in the same font printed at 12 point.  
The following illustration shows samples of a font printed  
in different point sizes:  
48 point 36 point  
24 point 18 point  
12 point  
10 point  
The point size of a font is defined as the distance from the  
top of the tallest character in the font to the bottom of the  
lowest character in the font. Due to the definition of point  
size, different fonts printed at the same point size may  
appear quite different in size. This is because there are  
other font parameters that affect how the font looks. How-  
ever, the point size of a font is an excellent specification of  
the relative size of a font. The following examples illus-  
trate two very different proportional fonts at 14 point:  
ITC Ava nt Ga rd e  
a b c d e fg hABCDEFGH  
ITC Zapf Chancery  
abcdefghABCDEFGH  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bitmapped and The printer uses both bitmapped and scalable fonts.  
Scalable Fonts  
Bitmapped fonts are stored in printer memory as pre-  
defined patterns of bits that represent a typeface at a spe-  
cific size, style and resolution. An example of a character  
from a bitmapped font is shown at left.  
Bitmapped fonts are available in different type styles and  
point sizes as downloadable fonts. Contact your point of  
purchase for more information about downloadable fonts.  
Scalable fonts are stored as computer programs that define  
the outlines of the characters in the font. Each time you  
print characters from a scalable font, the printer creates a  
bitmap of the characters at the point size you choose and  
saves it temporarily in printer memory. These temporary  
bitmapped fonts are deleted when you turn off or reset the  
printer. Scalable fonts provide the flexibility of printing in  
many different point sizes.  
Your printer uses different scalable font formats for down-  
loading fonts to the printer. PCL 6 emulation uses Intelli-  
font and TrueType scalable fonts. PostScript 3 emulation  
uses Type 1 and TrueType scalable fonts. There are thou-  
sands of different scalable fonts available in these different  
font formats from numerous font suppliers.  
If you plan to use many downloadable bitmapped or scal-  
able fonts or if you plan to use many different sizes of scal-  
able fonts, you may need to purchase additional memory  
for your printer. See page 206 for more information.  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Resident Fonts Your printer is equipped with resident fonts stored perma-  
nently in printer memory. Different fonts are available in  
PCL 6 and PostScript 3 emulations. Some of the most pop-  
ular typefaces, like Courier and Times New Roman, are  
available for all printer languages.  
The following tables list all the fonts resident in your  
printer. See page 242 for instructions on how to print sam-  
ples of the fonts. You can select the resident fonts from  
your software application, or from the operator panel if  
you are using PCL 6 emulation.  
Resident Scalable Fonts  
PCL 6 Emulation  
PostScript 3 Emulation  
AlbertusMT  
Albertus Medium  
AlbertusMT-Italic  
AlbertusMT-Light  
Albertus Extra Bold  
Antique Olive  
AntiqueOlive-Roman  
AntiqueOlive-Italic  
AntiqueOlive-Bold  
AntiqueOlive-Compact  
ArialMT  
Antique Olive Italic  
Antique Olive Bold  
Arial  
Arial Italic  
Arial-ItalicMT  
Arial Bold  
Arial-BoldMT  
Arial Bold Italic  
Arial-BoldItalicMT  
AvantGarde-Book  
AvantGarde-BookOblique  
AvantGarde-Demi  
AvantGarde-DemiOblique  
Bookman-Light  
ITC Avant Garde Book  
ITC Avant Garde Book Oblique  
ITC Avant Garde Demi  
ITC Avant Garde Demi Oblique  
ITC Bookman Light  
ITC Bookman Light Italic  
ITC Bookman Demi  
ITC Bookman Demi Italic  
Clarendon Condensed Bold  
Bookman-LightItalic  
Bookman-Demi  
Bookman-DemiItalic  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
Resident Scalable Fonts (continued)  
PCL 6 Emulation  
Coronet  
PostScript 3 Emulation  
Coronet-Regular  
Courier  
CourierPS  
CourierPS Oblique  
CourierPS Bold  
Courier-Oblique  
Courier-Bold  
CourierPS Bold Italic  
CG Omega  
Courier-BoldOblique  
CG Omega Bold  
CG Omega Italic  
CG Omega Bold Italic  
Garamond Antiqua  
Garamond Halbfett  
Garamond Kursiv  
Garamond Kursiv Halbfett  
Helvetica Light  
Garamond-Antiqua  
Garamond-Halbfett  
Garamond-Kursiv  
Garamond-KursivHalbfett  
Helvetica-Light  
Helvetica Light Oblique  
Helvetica Black  
Helvetica-LightOblique  
Helvetica-Black  
Helvetica Black Oblique  
Helvetica  
Helvetica-BlackOblique  
Helvetica  
Helvetica Italic  
Helvetica-Oblique  
Helvetica Bold  
Helvetica-Bold  
Helvetica Bold Italic  
Helvetica Narrow  
Helvetica Narrow Italic  
Helvetica Narrow Bold  
Helvetica Narrow Bold Italic  
CG Times  
Helvetica-BoldOblique  
Helvetica-Narrow  
Helvetica-Narrow-Oblique  
Helvetica-Narrow-Bold  
Helvetica-Narrow-BoldOblique  
Intl-CG-Times  
CG Times Italic  
Intl-CG-Times-Italic  
Intl-CG-Times-Bold  
Intl-CG-Times-BoldItalic  
CG Times Bold  
CG Times Bold Italic  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resident Scalable Fonts (continued)  
PCL 6 Emulation  
Univers Medium  
Univers Medium Italic  
Univers Bold  
PostScript 3 Emulation  
Intl-Univers-Medium  
Intl-Univers-MediumItalic  
Intl-Univers-Bold  
Intl-Univers-BoldItalic  
Intl-Courier  
Univers Bold Italic  
Courier  
Courier Italic  
Intl-Courier-Oblique  
Intl-Courier-Bold  
Intl-Courier-BoldOblique  
LetterGothic  
Courier Bold  
Courier Bold Italic  
Letter Gothic  
Letter Gothic Italic  
Letter Gothic Bold  
LetterGothic-Slanted  
LetterGothic-Bold  
LetterGothic-BoldSlanted  
Marigold  
Marigold  
Century Schoolbook Roman  
Century Schoolbook Italic  
Century Schoolbook Bold  
Century Schoolbook Bold Italic  
NewCenturySchlbk-Roman  
NewCenturySchlbk-Italic  
NewCenturySchlbk-Bold  
NewCenturySchlbk-BoldItalic  
Optima  
Optima-Bold  
Optima-BoldItalic  
Optima-Italic  
Palatino Roman  
Palatino Italic  
Palatino Bold  
Palatino Bold Italic  
SymbolPS  
Palatino-Roman  
Palatino-Italic  
Palatino-Bold  
Palatino-BoldItalic  
Symbol  
Symbol  
Times Roman  
Times Italic  
Times-Roman  
Times-Italic  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Resident Scalable Fonts (continued)  
PCL 6 Emulation  
PostScript 3 Emulation  
Times-Bold  
Times Bold  
Times Bold Italic  
Times-BoldItalic  
Times New Roman  
Times New Roman Italic  
Times New Roman Bold  
Times New Roman Bold Italic  
TimesNewRomanPSMT  
TimesNewRomanPS-ItalicMT  
TimesNewRomanPS-BoldMT  
TimesNewRomanPS-BoldItalicMT  
Univers  
Univers-Oblique  
Univers-Bold  
Univers-BoldOblique  
Univers-Condensed  
Univers-CondensedOblique  
Univers-CondensedBold  
Univers-CondensedBoldOblique  
Wingdings-Regular  
Univers Condensed Medium  
Univers Condensed Medium Italic  
Univers Condensed Bold  
Univers Condensed Bold Italic  
Wingdings  
ITC Zapf Chancery Medium Italic  
ITC Zapf Dingbats  
ZapfChancery-MediumItalic  
ZapfDingbats  
Resident Bitmapped Fonts  
PCL 6 Emulation  
Line Printer 16  
PostScript 3 Emulation  
POSTNET Barcode  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Symbol Sets A symbol set is the collection of alphabetic and numeric  
characters, punctuation, and special characters available  
in the font you select. Symbol sets support the require-  
ments for different languages or specific applications,  
such as math symbols used for scientific text.  
In PCL 6 emulation, a symbol set also defines which char-  
acter will print for each key on the keyboard (or more spe-  
cifically, for each code point). Some applications require  
different characters at some code points. To support multi-  
ple applications and languages, your printer has 83  
symbol sets for the resident PCL 6 emulation fonts.  
Symbol Sets for  
PCL 6 Emulation  
Not all font names support all of the symbol sets listed.  
Refer to the Technical Reference to determine which sym-  
bols sets are supported by each font name.  
ABICOMP Brazil/Portugal  
ABICOMP International  
DeskTop  
Legal  
MC Text  
Microsoft Publishing  
Russian-GOST  
Ukrainian  
PCL ITC Zapf Dingbats  
PS ITC Zapf Dingbats  
PS Math  
PS Text  
Pi Font  
Symbol  
Wingdings  
POSTNET Barcode  
ISO : German  
ISO : Spanish  
ISO 2: IRV (Int'l Ref Version)  
ISO 4: United Kingdom  
ISO 6: ASCII  
ISO 10: Swedish  
ISO 11: Swedish for Names  
ISO 14: JIS ASCII  
ISO 15: Italian  
ISO 16: Portuguese  
ISO 17: Spanish  
ISO 21: German  
ISO 25: French  
ISO 57: Chinese  
ISO 60: Norwegian version 1  
ISO 61: Norwegian version 2  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ISO 69: French  
ISO 84: Portuguese  
ISO 85: Spanish  
ISO 8859-1 Latin 1 (ECMA-94)  
ISO 8859-2 Latin 2  
ISO 8859-5 Latin/Cyrillic  
ISO 8859-7 Latin/Greek  
ISO 8859-9 Latin 5  
ISO 8859-10 Latin 6  
ISO 8859-15 Latin 9  
PC-8 Bulgarian  
PC-8 Danish/Norwegian (437N)  
PC-8 Greek Alternate (437G)  
PC-8 Turkish (437T)  
PC-8 Latin/Greek  
PC-8 PC Nova  
PC-8 Polish Mazovia  
PC-8 Code Page 437  
PC-775 Baltic (PC-8 Latin 6)  
PC-850 Multilingual  
PC-851 Greece  
PC-852 Latin 2  
PC-853 Latin 3 (Turkish)  
PC-855 Cyrillic  
PC-857 Latin 5 (Turkish)  
PC-858 Multilingual Euro  
PC-860 Portugal  
PC-861 Iceland  
PC-863 Canadian French  
PC-865 Nordic  
PC-866 Cyrillic  
PC-869 Greece  
PC-911 Katakana  
PC-1004 OS/2  
Math-8  
Greek-8  
Turkish-8  
Roman-8  
Roman-9  
Roman Extension  
Ventura ITC Zapf Dingbats  
Ventura International  
Ventura Math  
Ventura US  
Windows 3.0 Latin 1  
Windows 98 Cyrillic  
Windows 98 Greek  
Windows 98 Latin 1  
Windows 98 Latin 2  
Windows 98 Latin 5  
Windows 98 Latin 6 (Baltic)  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Downloadable You can download scalable fonts in PostScript 3 emulation  
and either scalable or bitmapped fonts in PCL 6 emula-  
Fonts  
tion. Fonts can be downloaded to printer memory or to a  
flash memory option or hard disk option. Fonts down-  
loaded to flash memory or hard disk remain in memory  
even after the printer language changes, the printer resets,  
or the printer is turned off.  
The MarkVision utility includes a remote management  
function that lets you manipulate the font files you have  
downloaded to flash memory or hard disk. See page 25 for  
more information about MarkVision.  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Printing a Font To print samples of all the fonts currently available for  
your printer:  
Sample List  
1 Make sure the printer power is On (| ) and the  
Ready status message appears on the display.  
2 Press Menu> or <Menu to enter the menus.  
3 Continue to press and release Menu> until you see  
UTILITIES MENU.  
4 Press Select.  
5 Press Menu> until Print Fonts appears.  
6 Press Select.  
7 Press Menu> or <Menu until either PCL Fonts or  
PS Fonts appears on the second line of the display.  
Select PCL Fonts to print a listing of the fonts  
available to the PCL emulator.  
Select PS Fonts to print a listing of the fonts avail-  
able to the PostScript 3 emulator.  
8 Press Select.  
The message Printing Font List appears and remains  
on the operator panel display until the page prints.  
The printer returns to the Ready state after the font  
sample list prints.  
Appendix A: Understanding Fonts  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Notices  
B
Electronic Emissions  
Notices  
Electronic emission information for your printer varies, depending on whether or not  
you have an optional network adapter installed.  
Warning  
With a network adapter installed, this is a Class A product. In a domestic environment,  
this product may cause radio interference, in which case the user may be required to  
take adequate measures.  
Without a Network  
Adapter Installed  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Compliance  
Information Statement  
The Lexmark Optra M410 and M412 laser printers, Type 4045, have been tested and  
found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not  
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
The FCC Class B limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful  
interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate  
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruc-  
tions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no  
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment  
does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be deter-  
mined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the  
interference by one or more of the following measures:  
Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver.  
Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different from that to which  
the receiver is connected.  
Consult your point of purchase or service representative for additional sug-  
gestions.  
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by  
using other than recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to  
this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could void the users authority  
to operate this equipment.  
Appendix B: Notices  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a Class  
B computing device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lexmark part  
number 1329605 for parallel and 12A2405 for USB. Use of a substitute cable not prop-  
erly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC regulations.  
Any questions regarding this compliance information statement should be directed to:  
Director of Lab Operations  
Lexmark International, Inc.  
740 West New Circle Road  
Lexington, KY 40550  
(606) 232-3000  
Industry Canada Compliance Statement  
This Class B digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-  
Causing Equipment Regulations.  
Avis de conformité aux normes d’Industrie Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe B respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le  
matériel brouilleur du Canada.  
European Community (EC) Directives Conformity  
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives  
89/ 336/ EEC and 73/ 23/ EEC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of  
the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility and safety of electrical  
equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits.  
A declaration of conformity with the requirements of the Directive has been signed by  
the Director of Manufacturing and Technical Support, Lexmark International, S.A., Boi-  
gny, France.  
This product satisfies the Class B limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN  
60950.  
Appendix B: Notices  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
With a Network Adapter  
Installed  
Federal Communications Commission (FCC) Compliance  
Information Statement  
The Lexmark Optra M410n and M412n laser printers, Type 4045, have been tested and  
found to comply with the limits for a Class A digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the  
FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not  
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
The FCC Class A limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful  
interference when the equipment is operated in a commercial environment. This equip-  
ment generates, uses, and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and  
used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to  
radio communications. Operation of this equipment in a residential area is likely to  
cause harmful interference in which case the user will be required to correct the interfer-  
ence at his own expense.  
The manufacturer is not responsible for any radio or television interference caused by  
using other than recommended cables or by unauthorized changes or modifications to  
this equipment. Unauthorized changes or modifications could void the users authority  
to operate this equipment.  
Note: To assure compliance with FCC regulations on electromagnetic interference for a  
Class A computing device, use a properly shielded and grounded cable such as Lex-  
mark part number 1329605 for parallel and 12A2405 for USB. Use of a substitute cable  
not properly shielded and grounded may result in a violation of FCC regulations.  
Industry Canada Compliance Statement  
This Class A digital apparatus meets all requirements of the Canadian Interference-  
Causing Equipment Regulations.  
Avis de conformité aux normes dIndustrie Canada  
Cet appareil numérique de la classe A respecte toutes les exigences du Règlement sur le  
matériel brouilleur du Canada.  
European Community (EC) Directives Conformity  
This product is in conformity with the protection requirements of EC Council directives  
89/ 336/ EEC and 73/ 23/ EEC on the approximation and harmonization of the laws of  
the Member States relating to electromagnetic compatibility and safety of electrical  
equipment designed for use within certain voltage limits.  
A declaration of conformity with the requirements of the Directive has been signed by  
the Director of Manufacturing and Technical Support, Lexmark International, S.A., Boi-  
gny, France.  
This product satisfies the Class A limits of EN 55022 and safety requirements of EN  
60950.  
Appendix B: Notices  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The United Kingdom  
Telecommunications Act  
1984  
This apparatus is approved under the approval number NS/ G/ 1234/ J/ 100003 for the  
indirect connections to the public telecommunications systems in the United Kingdom.  
German Acoustics  
Statement  
The following measurements were made in accordance with ISO 7779 and reported in  
conformance with ISO 9296.  
Acoustics  
1-Meter Average  
Sound Pressure,  
dBA  
Printing  
Idling  
Optra M410  
48 dBA  
Optra M412  
50 dBA  
30 dBA  
30 dBA  
Energy Star  
The EPA ENERGY STAR Computers program is a partnership effort with computer  
manufacturers to promote the introduction of energy-efficient products and to reduce  
air pollution caused by power generation.  
Companies participating in this program introduce personal computers, printers, moni-  
tors, or fax machines that power down when they are not being used. This feature will  
cut the energy used by up to 50 percent. Lexmark is proud to be a participant in this  
program.  
As an Energy Star Partner, Lexmark International, Inc. has determined that this product  
meets the Energy Star guidelines for energy efficiency.  
Appendix B: Notices  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
Laser Notices  
The following laser notice labels may be affixed to this printer as shown:  
Laser Advisory Label  
Appendix B: Notices  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Class 1 Laser  
Statement Label  
CLASS 1 LASER PRODUCT  
LASER KLASSE 1  
LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE  
APPAREIL À LASER DE CLASSE 1  
TO IEC 825  
Laser Notice  
The printer is certified in the U.S. to conform to the requirements of DHHS 21 CFR  
Subchapter J for Class I (1) laser products, and elsewhere is certified as a Class I laser  
product conforming to the requirements of IEC 60825-1.  
Class I laser products are not considered to be hazardous. The printer contains inter-  
nally a Class IIIb (3b) laser that is nominally a 5 milliwatt aluminum gallium arsenide  
laser operating in the wavelength region of 770-795 nanometers. The laser system and  
printer are designed so there is never any human access to laser radiation above a Class  
I level during normal operation, user maintenance, or prescribed service condition.  
Laser  
Der Drucker erfüllt gemäß amtlicher Bestätigung der USA die Anforderungen der  
Bestimmung DHHS (Department of Health and Human Services) 21 CFR Teil J für  
Laserprodukte der Klasse I (1). In anderen Ländern gilt der Drucker als Laserprodukt  
der Klasse I, der die Anforderungen der IEC (International Electrotechnical  
Commission) 60825-1 gemäß amtlicher Bestätigung erfüllt.  
Laserprodukte der Klasse I gelten als unschädlich. Der Drucker ist intern mit einem  
Laser der Klasse IIIb (3b) ausgestattet. Hierbei handelt es sich nominell um einen 5-  
Milliwatt-Aluminium-Galliumarsenidlaser, der in einem Wellenlängenbereich von 770  
bis 795 Nanometern arbeitet. Das Lasersystem und der Drucker sind so konzipiert, daß  
im Normalbetrieb, bei der Wartung durch den Benutzer oder bei ordnungsgemäßer  
Wartung durch den Kundendienst Laserbestrahlung, die die Klasse I übersteigen  
würde, Menschen keinesfalls erreicht.  
Appendix B: Notices  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Avis relatif à lutilisation  
Pour les Etats-Unis : cette imprimante est certifiée conforme aux provisions DHHS 21  
CFR alinéa J concernant les produits laser de Classe I (1). Pour les autres pays : cette  
imprimante répond aux normes IEC 60825-1 relatives aux produits laser de Classe I.  
de laser  
Les produits laser de Classe I sont considérés comme des produits non dangereux.  
L'imprimante contient un laser interne de classe IIIb (3b) ; il s'agit d'un laser semi-  
conducteur à arséniure de gallium de 5 mw en aluminim utilisant la plage de la  
longueur d'ondes située entre 770 et 795 nanomètres. Limprimante et son système laser  
sont conçus pour impossible, dans des conditions normales dutilisation, dentretien  
par lutilisateur ou de révision, lexposition à des rayonnements laser supérieurs à des  
rayonnements de Classe I .  
Avvertenze sui prodotti  
laser  
Questa stampante è certificata negli Stati Uniti per essere conforme ai requisiti del  
DHHS 21 CFR Sottocapitolo J per i prodotti laser di classe 1 ed è certificata negli altri  
Paesi come prodotto laser di classe 1 conforme ai requisiti della norma CEI 60825-1.  
I prodotti laser di classe non sono considerati pericolosi. La stampante contiene al suo  
interno un laser di Classe IIIb (3b) che è un laser all'arsenito gallio a 5 milliwatt di  
alluminio funzionante nell'intervallo di lunghezza d'onda di 770-795 nanometri. Il  
sistema laser e la stampante sono stati progettati in modo tale che le persone a contatto  
con la stampante, durante il normale funzionamento, le operazioni di servizio o quelle  
di assistenza tecnica, non ricevano radiazioni laser superiori al livello della classe 1.  
Avisos sobre el láser  
Declaração sobre laser  
Laserinformatie  
Se certifica que, en los EE.UU., esta impresora cumple los requisitos para los productos  
láser de Clase I (1) establecidos en el subcapítulo J de la norma CFR 21 del DHHS  
(Departamento de Sanidad y Servicios) y, en los demás países, reúne todas las  
condiciones expuestas en la norma IEC 60825-1 para productos láser de Clase I (1).  
Los productos láser de Clase I no se consideran peligrosos. La impresora contiene en su  
interior un láser de la clase IIIb (3b) que se trata de un láser de arseniuro de galio con 5  
milivatios de aluminio que funciona en el intervalo de longitud de onda entre 770 y 795  
nanómetros. El sistema láser y la impresora están diseñados de forma que ninguna  
persona pueda verse afectada por ningún tipo de radiación láser superior al nivel de la  
Clase I durante su uso normal, el mantenimiento realizado por el usuario o cualquier  
otra situación de servicio técnico.  
A impressora está certificada nos E.U.A. em conformidade com os requisitos da  
regulamentação DHHS 21 CFR Subcapítulo J para a Classe I (1) de produtos laser. Em  
outros locais, está certificada como um produto laser da Classe I, em conformidade com  
os requisitos da norma IEC 60825-1.  
Os produtos laser da Classe I não são considerados perigosos. A impressora contém no  
seu interior um laser Classe IIIb (3b) que é nominalmente um laser de 5 miliwatts de  
alumínio de arseneto de gálio a operar na região de comprimento de onda de 770-795  
nanómetros. O sistema e a impressora laser foram concebidos de forma a nunca existir  
qualquer possiblidade de acesso humano a radiação laser superior a um nível de Classe  
I durante a operação normal, a manutenção feita pelo utilizador ou condições de  
assistência prescritas.  
De printer voldoet aan de eisen die gesteld worden aan een laserprodukt van klasse I.  
Voor de Verenigde Staten zijn deze eisen vastgelegd in DHHS 21 CFR Subchapter J,  
voor andere landen in IEC 60825-1.  
Laserprodukten van klasse I worden niet als ongevaarlijk aangemerkt. De printer bevat  
een interne 5 aluminium milliwatt gallium arsenide laser van Klasse IIIb (3b) die werkt  
in de golflengte 770-795 nanometer. Het lasergedeelte en de printer zijn zo ontworpen  
dat bij normaal gebruik, bij onderhoud of reparatie conform de voorschriften, nooit  
blootstelling mogelijk is aan laserstraling boven een niveau zoals voorgeschreven is  
voor klasse 1.  
Appendix B: Notices  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lasermeddelelse  
Printeren er godkendt som et Klasse I-laserprodukt, i overenstemmelse med kravene i  
IEC 60825-1.  
Klasse I-laserprodukter betragtes ikke som farlige. Printeren indeholder en Class IIIb  
(3b)-laser, der nominelt er en 5 aluminum milliwatt gallium arsenid-laser, som arbejder  
i et bølgelængdeområde af 770-795 nanometer. Lasersystemet og printeren er udformet  
således, at mennesker aldrig udsættes for en laserstråling over Klasse I-niveau ved  
normal drift, brugervedligeholdelse eller obligatoriske servicebetingelser.  
Huomautus laserlaitteesta  
Tämä kirjoitin on Yhdysvalloissa luokan I (1) laserlaitteiden DHHS 21 CFR Subchapter J  
-määrityksen mukainen ja muualla luokan I laserlaitteiden IEC 60825-1 -määrityksen  
mukainen.  
Luokan I laserlaitteiden ei katsota olevan vaarallisia käyttäjälle. Tulostin sisältää luokan  
IIIb (3b) alumiinigalliumarsenidilaserin, joka toimii 5 milliwatin nimellisteholla ja 770 -  
795 nanometrin aallonpituusalueella. Laserjärjestelmä ja kirjoitin on suunniteltu siten,  
että käyttäjä ei altistu luokan I määrityksiä voimakkaammalle säteilylle kirjoittimen  
normaalin toiminnan, käyttäjän tekemien huoltotoimien tai muiden huoltotoimien  
yhteydessä.  
LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE  
VAROITUS! Laitteen käyttäminen muulla kuin tässä käyttöohjeessa mainitulla tavalla  
saattaa altistaa käyttäjän turvallisuusluokan 1 ylittävälle näkymättömälle  
lasersäteilylle.  
KLASS 1 LASER APPARAT  
VARNING! Om apparaten används på annat sätt än i denna bruksanvisning  
specificerats, kan användaren utsättas för osynlig laserstrålning, som överskrider  
gränsen för laserklass 1.  
Laser-notis  
Denna skrivare är i USA certifierad att motsvara kraven i DHHS 21 CFR, underparagraf  
J för laserprodukter av Klass I (1). I andra länder uppfyller skrivaren kraven för  
laserprodukter av Klass I enligt kraven i IEC 60825-1.  
Laserprodukter i Klass I anses ej hälsovådliga. Skrivaren innehåller en inbyggd 5  
milliwatts galliumarsenidlaser av klass IIIb (3b), som arbetar med våglänger i  
intervallet 770-795 nanometer. Lasersystemet och skrivaren är utformade så att det  
aldrig finns risk för att någon person utsätts för laserstrålning över Klass I-nivå vid  
normal användning, underhåll som utförs av användaren eller annan föreskriven  
serviceåtgärd.  
Laser-melding  
Skriveren er godkjent i USA etter kravene i DHHS 21 CFR, underkapittel J, for klasse I  
(1) laserprodukter, og er i andre land godkjent som et Klasse I-laserprodukt i samsvar  
med kravene i IEC 60825-1.  
Klasse I-laserprodukter er ikke å betrakte som farlige. Skriveren har en innebygd laser i  
klasse IIIb (3b) som nominelt er en 5 milliwatts galliumaluminiumarsenidlaser som  
opererer med bølgelengder i området 770-795 nanometer. Lasersystemet og skriveren er  
utformet slik at personer aldri utsettes for laserstråling ut over klasse I-nivå under  
vanlig bruk, vedlikehold som utføres av brukeren, eller foreskrevne serviceoperasjoner.  
Appendix B: Notices  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Avís sobre el làser  
Segons ha estat certificat als Estats Units, aquesta impressora compleix els requisits de  
DHHS 21 CFR, apartat J, pels productes làser de classe I (1), i segons ha estat certificat  
en altres llocs, és un producte làser de classe I que compleix els requisits dIEC 60825-1.  
Els productes làser de classe I no es consideren perillosos. La impressora conté  
internament un làser de la classe IIIb (3b) que nominalment es tracta d'un làser  
d'arsenur de gal·li amb 5 milivats d'alumini que funciona a l'interval de longitud d'ona  
entre 770 i 795 nanòmetres. El sistema làser i la impressora han sigut concebuts de  
manera que mai hi hagi exposició a la radiació làser per sobre dun nivell de classe I  
durant una operació normal, durant les tasques de manteniment dusuari ni durant els  
serveis que satisfacin les condicions prescrites.  
Chinese Laser Notice  
Appendix B: Notices  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix B: Notices  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety  
Information  
C
Safety Information  
If your product is NOT marked with this symbol  
to an electrical outlet that is properly grounded.  
, it MUST be connected  
The power cord must be connected to an electrical outlet that is near the prod-  
uct and easily accessible.  
Refer service or repairs, other than those described in the operating instruc-  
tions, to a professional service person.  
This product is designed, tested and approved to meet strict global safety stan-  
dards with the use of specific Lexmark components. The safety features of  
some parts may not always be obvious. Lexmark is not responsible for the use  
of other replacement parts.  
Your product uses a laser, exercise  
CAUTION: Use of controls or adjustments or performance of procedures  
other than those specified herein may result in hazardous radiation  
exposure.  
Your product uses a printing process that heats the print media, and the heat  
may cause the media to release emissions. You must understand the section in  
your operating instructions that discusses the guidelines for selecting print  
media to avoid the possibility of harmful emissions.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Consignes de sécurité  
Si le symbole  
branché sur une prise de courant mise à la terre.  
n'apparaît PAS sur votre produit, ce dernier DOIT être  
Le câble d'alimentation doit être connecté à une prise de courant placée près  
du produit et facilement accessible.  
L'entretien et les réparations autres que ceux décrits dans les instructions  
d'emploi doivent être effectués par le personnel de maintenance qualifié.  
Ce produit a été conçu, testé et approuvé pour respecter les normes strictes de  
sécurité globale lors de l'utilisation de composants Lexmark spécifiques. Les  
caractéristiques de sécurité de certains éléments ne sont pas toujours évi-  
dentes. Lexmark ne peut être tenu responsable de l'utilisation d'autres pièces  
de rechange.  
Le produit utilise un laser :  
ATTENTION : Les commandes, les réglages et l'exécution de toute autre  
procédure que celle indiquée dans le présent document peuvent entraîner  
des risques de radiations.  
Le produit utilise un système d'impression qui chauffe le support d'impres-  
sion duquel peuvent alors se dégager des émissions. Vous devez consulter les  
directives générales dans la section appropriée des instructions d'emploi pour  
savoir comment empêcher que ces émissions ne se produisent.  
Norme di sicurezza  
Se il prodotto NON è contrassegnato con questo simbolo  
legato lo stesso ad una presa elettrica con messa a terra.  
DEVE essere col-  
Il cavo di alimentazione deve essere collegato ad una presa elettrica posta  
nelle vicinanze del prodotto e facilmente raggiungibile.  
Per la manutenzione o le riparazioni, escluse quelle descritte nelle istruzioni  
operative, consultare il personale di assistenza autorizzato.  
Il prodotto è stato progettato, testato e approvato in conformità a severi stan-  
dard di sicurezza e per lutilizzo con componenti Lexmark specifici. Le carat-  
teristiche di sicurezza di alcune parti non sempre sono di immediata  
comprensione. Lexmark non è responsabile per lutilizzo di parti di ricambio  
di altri produttori.  
Poiché il prodotto in questione utilizza il laser, considerare il seguente avverti-  
mento:  
ATTENZIONE: L'uso di dispositivi di controllo o di regolazione, o l'esecuz-  
ione di procedure non incluse tra quelle descritte in questa documentazi-  
one, può provocare una pericolosa esposizione alle radiazioni.  
Il prodotto in questione utilizza un processo di stampa che riscalda i supporti  
di stampa; il calore generato può determinare l'emissione di sostanze dannose  
da parte dei supporti. Leggere attentamente la sezione riportata nelle istruzi-  
oni riguardante le operazioni di selezione dei supporti di stampa in modo da  
evitare la possibilità di emissioni dannose.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sicherheitshinweise  
Falls der Drucker nicht mit diesem Symbol  
ordnungsgemäß geerdete Steckdose angeschlossen werden.  
markiert ist, muß er an eine  
Das Netzkabel muß an eine Steckdose angeschlossen werden, die sich in der  
Nähe des Geräts befindet und leicht zugänglich ist.  
Wartungsarbeiten und Reparaturen, mit Ausnahme der in der Betriebsanlei-  
tung näher beschriebenen, sollten Fachleuten überlassen werden.  
Dieses Produkt und die zugehörigen Komponenten wurden entworfen und  
getestet, um beim Einsatz die weltweit gültigen Sicherheitsanforderungen zu  
erfüllen. Die sicherheitsrelevanten Funktionen der Bauteile und Optionen sind  
nicht immer offensichtlich. Sofern Teile eingesetzt werden, die nicht von Lex-  
mark sind, wird von Lexmark keinerlei Verantwortung oder Haftung für  
dieses Produkt übernommen.  
Dieses Produkt verwendet einen Laser. Wenden Sie daher besondere  
VORSICHT an: Die Verwendung von Kontrollen bzw. die Regulierung von  
Vorgängen mit Ausnahme derjenigen, die in dieser Betriebsanleitung  
behandelt werden, kann Sie gefährlicher Bestrahlung aussetzen.  
Dieses Produkt verwendet ein Druckverfahren, bei dem das Druckmedium  
erhitzt wird. Diese Erwärmung kann zu einer Freigabe von Emissionen des  
Druckmediums führen. Es ist daher wichtig, daß Sie in der Betriebsanleitung  
den Abschnitt, der sich mit der Auswahl geeigneter Druckmedien befaßt,  
sorgfältig durchlesen und die dort aufgeführten Richtlinien befolgen, um der  
Gefahr schädlicher Emissionen vorzubeugen.  
Pautas de Seguridad  
Si su producto NO tiene este símbolo,  
una toma de corriente eléctrica con toma de tierra correcta.  
, es IMPRESCINDIBLE conectarlo a  
El cable de alimentación deberá conectarse a una toma de corriente situada  
cerca del producto y de fácil acceso.  
Cualquier servicio o reparación deberá realizarse por parte del personal cuali-  
ficado, a menos que se trate de las averías descritas en las instrucciones de uti-  
lización.  
Este producto se ha diseñado, verificado y aprobado para cumplir los más  
estrictos estándares de seguridad global usando los componentes específicos  
de Lexmark. Puede que las características de seguridad de algunas piezas no  
sean siempre evidentes. Lexmark no se hace responsable del uso de otras pie-  
zas de recambio.  
El producto utiliza un láser. Actúe con  
PRECAUCION: El uso de los controles o ajustes o el llevar a cabo proced-  
imientos distintos a los especificados aquí puede causar niveles de radi-  
ación peligrosos.  
Durante el proceso de impresión que utiliza este producto se calienta el medio  
de impresión, y el calor puede provocar que el medio emita gases. Para evitar  
emisiones peligrosas, el usuario deberá comprender y seguir lo expuesto en la  
sección de las instrucciones de utilización donde se describen las directrices  
para seleccionar el medio de impresión.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Veiligheidsvoorschriften  
Zorg ervoor dat uw produkt is aangesloten op een geaard stopcontact als het  
produkt NIET is gemarkeerd met det symbool  
.
Het netsnoer moet worden aangesloten op een gemakkelijk bereikbaar stop-  
contact in de buurt van het produkt.  
Neem contact op met een professionele onderhoudstechnicus voor onderhoud  
en reparaties die niet in de bij het produkt geleverde instructies beschreven  
worden.  
Dit product is ontworpen, getest en goedgekeurd om te voldoen aan strenge  
internationale veiligheidsvoorschriften. Deveiligheidsvoorzieningen van  
bepaalde onderdelen zullen niet altijd duidelijk zichtbaar zijn. Lexmark is niet  
verantwoordelijk voor het gebruik van andere vervangende onderdelen.  
Uw produkt maakt gebruik van een laser, wees  
VOORZICHTIG: Instellen van het controlepaneel of, aanpassingen of  
uitvoering van procedures op andere wijze dan hier is gespecificeerd kun-  
nen leiden tot blootstelling aan gevaarlijke straling.  
Uw produkt gebruikt een afdrukproces waarbij het afdrukmateriaal verhit  
raakt. Hierdoor kan straling vrijkomen. Lees het gedeelte in de bij het produkt  
geleverde instructies, waarin richtlijnen voor de keuze van afdrukmateriaal  
worden beschreven, zorgvuldig door, zodat u mogelijke schadelijke straling  
kunt voorkomen.  
Sikkerhedsoplysninger  
Hvis dit produkt IKKE er markeret med dette symbol  
til en stikkontakt med jordforbindelse.  
, SKAL det sluttes  
Ledningen skal sluttes til en stikkontakt, der er tæt på produktet og som er let  
tilgængelig.  
Service og reparationer, som ikke er beskrevet i brugsanvisningen, skal  
udføres af en kvalificeret tekniker.  
Dette produkt er udviklet, testet og godkendt i overensstemmelse med Lex-  
marks verdensomspændende standarder for sikkerhed. Delenes sikkerheds-  
funktioner kan være skjulte. Lexmark påtager sig intet ansvar for brugen af  
uoriginale reservedele.  
Dit produkt bruger en laser og du skal være  
FORSIGTIG: Brug af styremekanismer, indstillinger eller fremgangsmåder,  
som ikke er beskrevet her, kan resultere i farlig radioaktiv bestråling.  
Produktet benytter en udskrivningsproces, der opvarmer skrivemediet og  
denne varme kan føre til at udskriftmedier afgiver dampe. Det er vigtigt at du  
forstår den del af brugsanvisningen, der omhandler valg af udskriftsmedium,  
så du kan undgå farlige dampe.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sikkerhetsinformasjon  
Hvis produktet ditt ikke er merket med dette symbolet,  
kobles til en stikkontakt som er jordet.  
, må det bare  
Ledningen må være koblet til en stikkontakt nær produktet. Stikkontakten må  
være lett tilgjengelig.  
La bare kvalifisert personale ta seg av service og reparasjon som ikke er  
direkte beskrevet i bruksanvisningen.  
Dette produktet er utviklet, testet og godkjent i overensstemmelse med  
strenge verdensomspennende sikkerhetsstandarder for bestemte Lexmark-  
deler. Delenes sikkerhetsfunksjoner kan være skjulte. Lexmark er ikke ans-  
varlig for bruk av uoriginale reservedeler.  
Produktet ditt bruker en laser.  
ADVARSEL: Bruk av styremekanismer, innstillinger eller fremgangsmåter  
som ikke er beskrevet her, kan resultere i farlig utstråling.  
Produktet ditt bruker en utskriftsprosess som varmer opp skrivemediet, og  
varmen kan føre til utslipp. Forsikre deg om at du forstår den delen av bruk-  
sanvisningen som omhandler valg av utskriftsmedium, slik at du kan unngå  
farlige utslipp.  
Säkerhetsanvisningar  
Om produkten INTE är märkt med denna symbol  
till ett jordat vägguttag.  
MÅSTE den anslutas  
Nätkabeln måste anslutas till ett lättåtkomligt vägguttag i närheten av maski-  
nen.  
Låt endast utbildad servicepersonal utföra sådan service och sådana repara-  
tioner som inte beskrivs i handledningen.  
Denna produkt är utformad, testad och godkänd för att uppfylla interna-  
tionella säkerhetsbestämmelser när den används tillsammans med andra Lex-  
mark-produkter. Säkerhetsegenskaperna för vissa delar är inte helt  
uppenbara. Lexmark frånsäger sig ansvaret om delar av ett annat fabrikat  
används.  
Var försiktig - maskinen använder laser.  
VARNING! Det finns risk att du utsätter dig för hälsovådlig strålning om  
du använder andra reglage eller justeringar, eller om du utför andra proce-  
durer än de som beskrivs här.  
Maskinen använder en utskriftsmetod som upphettar utskriftsmaterialet. Het-  
tan kan i vissa fall leda till att materialet avger partiklar. Undvik skadliga par-  
tiklar genom att noga läsa det avsnitt i handledningen som beskriver hur man  
väljer utskriftsmaterial.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Informació de Seguretat  
Si el vostre producte NO està marcat amb el símbol  
nectar a una presa elèctrica de terra.  
, SHAURÀ de con-  
El cable de potència shaurà de connectar a una presa de corrent propera al  
producte i fàcilment accessible.  
Si heu de fer una reparació que no figuri entre les descrites a les instruccions  
de funcionament, confieu-la a un professional.  
Aquest producte està dissenyat, comprovat i aprovat per tal d'acomplir les  
estrictes normes de seguretat globals amb la utililització de components espe-  
cífics de Lexmark. Les característiques de seguretat d'algunes peces pot ser  
que no sempre siguin òbvies. Lexmark no es responsabilitza de l'us d'altres  
peces de recanvi.  
El vostre producte funciona amb un làser. Procediu amb  
PRECAUCIÓ: La utilització de controls, els ajustaments o la realització de  
procediments distints dels especificats aquí poden donar lloc a una  
exposició a radiacions perillosa.  
El vostre producte fa servir un procediment dimpressió que escalfa el mitjà  
dimpressió, i la calor pot fer que aquest mitjà alliberi emissions. Llegiu atenta-  
ment lapartat de les instruccions de funcionament on sexposen les directrius  
de selecció del mitjà demissió per tal devitar la possibilitat demissions  
nocives.  
Turvaohjeet  
Jos tuotteessa ei ole tätä tunnusta,  
pistorasiaan.  
, sen saa kytkeä vain maadoitettuun  
Tuotteen verkkojohto on kytkettävä sitä lähellä olevaan pistorasiaan.  
Varmista, että kulku pistorasian luo on esteetön.  
Muut kuin käyttöohjeissa mainitut huolto- tai korjaustoimet on jätettävä huol-  
toedustajalle.  
Tämä tuote on testattu ja hyväksytty. Se täyttää korkeat maailmanlaajuiset tur-  
vallisuusvaatimukset, kun siinä käytetään tiettyjä Lexmarkin valmistusosia.  
Joidenkin osien turvallisuusominaisuudet eivät aina ole itsestään selviä. Lex-  
mark ei vastaa muiden kuin alkuperäisten osien käytöstä.  
Laite sisältää lasertuotteen.  
Varoitus: Muiden kuin tässä mainittujen säätöjen tai toimien teko voi saat-  
taa käyttäjän alttiiksi vaaralliselle säteilylle.  
Tulostusmateriaali kuumenee tulostusprosessin aikana. Lämmön vaikutuk-  
sesta materiaalista saattaa irrota haitallisia aineita. Voit välttää haitalliset  
päästöt noudattamalla käyttöohjeissa annettuja tulostusmateriaalien valintao-  
hjeita.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Informações de Segurança  
Se o produto NÃO estiver marcado com este símbolo,  
a uma tomada com ligação à terra.  
, é necessário ligá-lo  
O cabo deve ser ligado a uma tomada localizada perto do produto e facilmente  
acessível.  
Para todos os serviços ou reparações não referidos nas instruções de operação,  
deve contactar um técnico dos serviços de assistência.  
Este produto foi concebido, testado e aprovado para satisfazer os padrões glo-  
bais de segurança na utilização de componentes específicos da Lexmark. As  
funções de segurança de alguns dos componentes podem não ser sempre  
óbvias. A Lexmark não é responsável pela utilização de outros componentes  
de substituição.  
O produto utiliza raios laser, tome  
CUIDADO: O uso de controlos, ajustamentos ou a execução de procedimen-  
tos diferentes dos especificados podem ocasionar exposição perigosa a radi-  
ações.  
O produto utiliza um processo de impressão que aquece os materiais de  
impressão. Devido ao aquecimento, estes podem libertar emissões radioacti-  
vas. É necessário compreender as instruções de operação relativas à escolha  
dos materiais de impressão a fim de evitar emissões perigosas.  
Informações de Segurança  
Se o produto NÃO estiver marcado com este símbolo,  
conectado a uma tomada elétrica com ligação à terra.  
, ele DEVE SER  
O cabo de alimentação deve ser conectado a uma tomada elétrica localizada  
perto do produto e de fácil acesso.  
Para todos os serviços ou reparações não descritos nas instruções de operação,  
entre em contato com um técnico dos serviços de assistência.  
Este produto está projetado, testado e aprovado para satisfazer os padrões glo-  
bais de segurança para uso de componentes específicos da Lexmark. Os recur-  
sos de segurança de alguns componentes podem não ser sempre óbvios. A  
Lexmark não é responsável pelo uso de outros componentes de substituição.  
O produto usa raios laser, tome  
CUIDADO: O uso de controles, ajustes ou a execução de procedimentos  
diferentes dos especificados podem resultar em exposição perigosa a radi-  
ações.  
O produto usa um processo de impressão que aquece o meio de impressão.  
Devido ao aquecimento, o meio pode liberar emissões. É necessário que você  
entenda as instruções de operação sobre a escolha do meio de impressão, para  
evitar emissões perigosas.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix C: Safety Information  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warranty  
D
Statement of Limited  
Warranty  
Lexmark International, Inc., Lexington, KY  
This warranty applies to the United States and Canada. For customers outside the U.S.  
and Canada, refer to the country-specific warranty information that came with your  
printer.  
Lexmark Optra M410 and  
M412 Laser Printers  
This Statement of Limited Warranty applies to this product if it was originally pur-  
chased for your use, and not for resale, from Lexmark or a Lexmark remarketer, referred  
to in this statement as Remarketer.”  
Warranty  
Lexmark warrants that this product:  
Is manufactured from new parts, or new and serviceable used parts, which per-  
form like new parts,  
Is free from defects in material and workmanship,  
Conforms to Lexmarks official published specifications, and  
Is in good working order.  
If this product does not function as warranted during the warranty period, contact a  
Remarketer or Lexmark for repair without charge.  
If this product is a feature or option, this statement applies only when that feature or  
option is used with the product for which it was designed. To obtain warranty service,  
you may be required to present the feature or option with the product.  
If you transfer this product to another user, warranty service under the terms of this  
statement is available to that user for the remainder of the warranty period. You should  
transfer proof of original purchase and this statement to that user.  
Appendix D: Warranty  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
Warranty Service  
The warranty period is 12 months and starts on the date of original purchase as shown  
on the purchase receipt.  
To obtain warranty service you may be required to present proof of original purchase.  
Warranty service will be provided at your location.at a Remarketer or a Lexmark desig-  
nated location. You may be required to deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lex-  
mark, or ship it prepaid and suitably packaged to a Lexmark designated location. You  
are responsible for loss of, or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the  
designated location.at a Lexmark designated location.  
at your location.  
at a Remarketer or a Lexmark designated location. You may be required to  
deliver your product to the Remarketer or Lexmark, or ship it prepaid and suit-  
ably packaged to a Lexmark designated location. You are responsible for loss of,  
or damage to, a product in transit to the Remarketer or the designated location.  
at a Lexmark designated location.  
When warranty service involves the exchange of a product or part, the item replaced  
becomes the property of the Remarketer or Lexmark. The replacement may be a new or  
repaired item. The replacement item assumes the remaining warranty period of the  
original product.  
Replacement is not available to you if the product you present for exchange is defaced,  
altered, in need of a repair not included in warranty service, or damaged beyond repair.  
Also, such product must be free of any legal obligation or restrictions that prevent its  
exchange.  
Before you present this product for warranty service, remove all programs, data, and  
removable storage media.  
For further explanation of your warranty alternatives and the nearest Lexmark autho-  
rized servicer in your area, please contact Lexmark at 1-800-LEXMARK (1-800-539-  
6275), or on the World Wide Web at http:/ / www.lexmark.com.  
Free remote technical support is provided for this product throughout its warranty  
period. Lexmark offers a variety of extended warranty programs that include an exten-  
sion of technical support. For products no longer covered by a Lexmark warranty, tech-  
nical support may only be available for a fee.  
Extent of Warranty  
We do not warrant uninterrupted or error-free operation of a product.  
Warranty service does not include repair of failures caused by:  
modification or attachments  
accidents or misuse  
unsuitable physical or operating environment  
maintenance by anyone other than Lexmark or a Lexmark authorized servicer  
operation of a product beyond the limit of its duty cycle  
failure to have installed a maintenance kit as specified (if applicable)  
use of printing media outside of Lexmark specifications  
use of other than Lexmark supplies (such as toner cartridges, inkjet cartridges,  
and ribbons)  
use of other than Lexmark product or component  
ALL EXPRESS AND IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WAR-  
RANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PUR-  
POSE, ARE LIMITED IN DURATION TO THE WARRANTY PERIOD. NO  
WARRANTIES, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, WILL APPLY AFTER THIS PERIOD.  
Appendix D: Warranty  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Limitation of Liability  
Your sole remedy under this Statement of Limited Warranty is set forth in this section.  
For any claim concerning performance or nonperformance of Lexmark or a Remarketer  
for this product under this Statement of Limited Warranty, you may recover actual  
damages up to the limit set forth in the following paragraph.  
Lexmark's liability for actual damages from any cause whatsoever will be limited to the  
greater of 1) $5,000 or 2) the amount you paid for the product that caused the damages.  
This limitation of liability will not apply to claims by you for bodily injury or damage to  
real property or tangible personal property for which Lexmark is legally liable. In no  
event will Lexmark be liable for any lost profits, lost savings, incidental damage, or  
other economic consequential damages. This is true even if you advise Lexmark or a  
Remarketer of the possibility of such damages. Lexmark is not liable for any claim by  
you based on a third party claim.  
This limitation of remedies also applies to any developer of materials supplied to Lex-  
mark. Lexmarks and the developers limitations of remedies are not cumulative. Such  
developer is an intended beneficiary of this limitation.  
Additional Rights  
Some states do not allow limitations on how long an implied warranty lasts, or do not  
allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages. If such laws  
apply, the limitations or exclusions contained in this statement may not apply to you.  
This warranty gives you specific legal rights. You may also have other rights which vary  
from state to state.  
Appendix D: Warranty  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Appendix D: Warranty  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Glossary  
Numerics 7 3/4 Envelope. See Monarch.  
9 Envelope. An envelope measuring 98.4 x 225.4 mm  
(3.875 x 8.875 in.).  
10 Envelope. See Com-10.  
500-sheet optional drawer. An optional input tray and  
drawer you can purchase for the printer to increase input  
capacity.  
1200 Image Quality. A print resolution setting that lets  
the printer to vary the size of each printed pixel, thereby  
producing a continuous tone effect. This setting improves  
the print quality of graphic fills, images, and halftones.  
A
A4. Print material measuring 210 x 297 mm  
(8.27 x 11.7 in.).  
A5. Print material measuring 148 x 210 mm  
(5.83 x 8.27 in.).  
all points addressable (APA). In computer graphics, the  
ability to address and display, or not display, each picture  
element (pel) on a display surface.  
APA. See all points addressable.  
application. See software application.  
Glossary  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
attendance message. An operator panel message that  
describes a printer problem. Operator intervention is  
required before the printer can continue processing.  
automated fax system. A Lexmark system for providing  
customers with quick product information, technical tips,  
and printer driver information.  
automatic interface. A printer function that determines  
the active interface: parallel, serial, network, infrared,  
LocalTalk, or USB.  
B
B5. (1) Envelope measuring 176 x 250 mm (6.93 x 9.84 in.).  
(2) Print material measuring 182 x 257 mm  
(7.17 x 10.12 in.).  
baud. The rate, in bits per second (bps), at which data is  
transferred to or from the computer through the serial  
interface.  
bidirectional communication. Two-way communication  
between the printer and a computer, using Network  
Printing Alliance Protocol (NPAP 1.0 standard).  
bin. See output bin.  
bitmapped font. Predefined pattern of bits that represent  
a typeface at a specific size, style, and resolution.  
bits per second (bps). A measurement of the speed of  
data transferred through a serial interface.  
bps. See bits per second.  
buffer. A portion of memory used to temporarily store  
data.  
Glossary  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Busy. A printer state in which the printer is processing  
data or printing pages.  
byte. A group of eight binary digits processed as a unit.  
Typically used to represent an alphanumeric character.  
C
C5. Envelope measuring 162 x 229 mm (6.38 x 9.01 in.).  
card stock. Heavy, single-ply print material frequently  
used for reports or book covers.  
Centronics parallel interface. A standard for connecting  
printers and other peripheral devices to a computer. It  
defines the plug, socket and electrical signals that are used  
for controlling the transmission of data.  
characters per inch (cpi). The number of characters that  
can be printed in one inch.  
Com-10. Also called a 10 Envelope. An envelope  
measuring 104.8 x 241.3 mm (4.125 x 9.5 in.).  
configuration. (1) The arrangement of a computer system,  
printer, or network. (2) The devices and programs that  
make up a system, subsystem, or network.  
corona wire. A thin wire in the printer that electrically  
charges the print material to attract toner from the  
photoconductor.  
curl. Curvature at the edge of a sheet of print material.  
D
Data Set Ready (DSR). A handshakingsignal  
contained in a serial interface indicating the device is  
ready to exchange information.  
data stream. Print data and printer control information  
that flows from the host system (computer) to the printer  
without interruption.  
Glossary  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Data Terminal Ready (DTR). A handshakingsignal  
contained in a serial interface indicating the device is  
ready to exchange information.  
default. An attribute, value, or setting that is assumed  
when none is explicitly specified.  
disk. See hard disk option.  
display. See operator panel display.  
DL. Envelope measuring 110 x 220 mm (4.33 x 8.66 in.).  
download. To transfer information, such as fonts, from a  
diskette or other device to your computer or printer for  
temporary or permanent storage.  
dpi. Dots per inch. See resolution.  
DRAM. See dynamic random access memory.  
driver. See printer driver.  
DSR. See Data Set Ready.  
DTR. See Data Terminal Ready.  
duplex. To print on both sides of a sheet of print material.  
dynamic random access memory (DRAM). Memory that  
allows rapid storage and retrieval of data. DRAM contents  
are erased when electrical power is turned off.  
E
emulation. Imitation of a printer processing language. For  
example, PCL 6 emulation imitates the Hewlett-Packard  
LaserJet printer language.  
ENA. External network adapter. See external print server.  
error message. See attendance message.  
Glossary  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ethernet. A network with a bus topology that utilizes  
carrier sense multiple access with collision detection  
(CSMA/ CD). An Ethernet network may be installed using  
any of three cabling systems:  
Ethernet 10Base2 (using RG-58 coax)  
Ethernet 10BaseT (using telephone twisted pair  
cable)  
Ethernet 100BaseTX  
executive. Print material measuring 184.2 x 266.7 mm  
(7.25 x 10.5 in.).  
external network adapter (ENA). See external print server.  
external print server. Also called an external network  
adapter (ENA). A LAN device that attaches externally to  
the printer and lets you connect various printers to your  
network, thereby freeing dedicated PC print servers for  
use as LAN workstations.  
F
factory default. Printer setting defined when the printer is  
manufactured.  
Fastbytes protocol. A parallel printer protocol that  
enables the printer to receive information at faster than  
normal transmission rates.  
fixed-pitch font. A font that prints each character in a  
fixed amount of horizontal space, regardless of the width  
of the character. These fonts are identified by the number  
of characters that print in 1 inch of horizontal line space,  
such as 10 pitch or 12 pitch.  
flash memory. Optional memory you can install in the  
printer to provide non-volatile storage for downloaded  
fonts, symbol sets, or macros.  
Glossary  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
font. A family or set of characters that have common  
visual characteristics, such as size, weight, and style; for  
example, Arial Bold.  
fuser. The part of the printer that uses heat and pressure  
to make toner adhere to the print material.  
G
H
grain. The alignment of the paper fibers in a sheet of print  
material. For example, in grain long paper, the fibers run  
the length of the page.  
g/m². Grams per square meter. Metric measurement for  
print material weight.  
handshaking. The exchange of predetermined signals  
when a connection is established.  
hard disk option. An optional device you can install in  
the printer to provide non-volatile storage for  
downloaded fonts, symbol sets, or macros.  
hex trace. A diagnostic printer mode that lets you print  
the uninterpreted printer data stream so you can see a  
hexadecimal and character representation of a print job.  
Honor INIT. A printer setting that allows the printer to be  
reset by an initialization signal sent from the computer.  
I
images. Visual data typically scanned from original  
sources external to the PC, such as photographs or video  
frames.  
INA. Internal network adapter. See internal print server.  
infrared adapter. An external device that uses a low-  
power infrared beam to allow a computer to exchange  
data with a printer without a physical connection between  
the two.  
Glossary  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
input source. A printer tray or the multipurpose feeder.  
An input source holds print material for printing.  
Integrated Network Option. See print server.  
interface. The connection between the computer and the  
printer.  
internal network adapter (INA). See internal print server.  
internal print server. Also called an internal network  
adapter (INA). An optional card you can install in the  
printer to connect it to a local area network (LAN).  
J
job accounting. A printer feature that lets you store  
statistical information about most recent printer jobs on a  
hard disk option installed in the printer.  
job buffering. A printer feature that lets you spool print  
jobs to a hard disk option installed in the printer.  
K
L
KB. Kilobyte; 1024 bytes.  
LAN. See local area network.  
landscape orientation. Printed page orientation in which  
the width of the page is greater than the height.  
LCD. See liquid crystal display.  
leading edge. The edge of the printed page that exits the  
printer first.  
legal. Print material measuring 215.9 x 356 mm  
(8.5 x 14 in.).  
letter. Print material measuring 215.9 x 279.4 mm  
(8.5 x 11 in.).  
Glossary  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
lines per page (lpp). The number of lines of text that can  
be printed on one page.  
link. The connection between the computer system or  
local area network and the printer.  
liquid crystal display (LCD). The display technology that  
shows operator panel messages and menu selections.  
local area network (LAN). A computer network located  
on a users premises within a limited geographical area.  
long-edge binding. A printer setting that arranges the  
orientation and layout of a duplexed page to be bound  
along the long side of the page.  
LPTx. A representation of one of the logical parallel ports  
(for example, LPT1) on a personal computer.  
M
macro. A collection of commands grouped together and  
temporarily or permanently stored in printer memory.  
manual feed. A process of feeding print material (paper,  
envelope, label, transparency, card stock) into the  
multipurpose feeder on the printer one sheet at a time.  
MarkNet S. Family of multi-protocol Lexmark internal  
print servers. Ethernet and Token-Ring versions are  
available.  
MarkNet XLe. Family of multi-protocol Lexmark external  
print servers. Ethernet, Token-Ring, and LocalTalk  
versions are available.  
MarkVision. A printer utility that provides continuous  
printer status and lets you configure multiple printers  
from a single setup file.  
MB. Megabyte; 1,048,576 bytes.  
media. See print material.  
Glossary  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
menu. A list of choices that control printer operation,  
printer features, and the appearance of the printed page.  
menu item. See setting.  
Monarch. Also called a 7 3/ 4 Envelope. An envelope  
measuring 98.4 x 190.5 mm (3.875 x 7.5 in.).  
monospaced font. A font in which the space for each  
character does not vary, regardless of the width of the  
character.  
multipurpose feeder. A print material input source on the  
front of the printer that lets you load a small stack of  
paper, envelopes, transparencies, labels, and odd-size  
print material. You can also use the multipurpose feeder  
to manually feed print material into the printer one sheet  
at a time.  
N
network. A group of computers, printers, and other  
hardware devices connected to each other to share  
information.  
network adapter. See print server.  
non-volatile random access memory (NVRAM).  
Memory that allows rapid storing and retrieving of data.  
NVRAM contents are preserved when electrical power is  
turned off.  
Not Ready. A printer state in which the printer does not  
accept data from the computer. This state is initiated  
either by operator intervention or a printer error.  
O
operating system. The basic software which provides the  
low-level functions needed to operate your computer,  
such as booting up.  
Operation ReSource. A Lexmark process established to  
recycle toner cartridges and print units.  
Glossary  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
operator panel. The buttons and liquid crystal display  
(LCD) on the printer that are used to change printer  
settings and display printer status.  
operator panel display. The liquid crystal display on the  
operator panel that shows printer menus and messages.  
operator panel overlay. An adhesive label with translated  
names for the operator panel display buttons and  
numbers in one language. A package of overlays is  
supplied for you to select the label with the language you  
need.  
orientation. A page description defining whether the  
printed text runs along the short edge (portrait) or the  
long edge (landscape) of the page.  
Other Envelope. Value to select for all envelopes that are  
not a standard size; defaults to 229.11 x 356 mm  
(9.02 x 14 in.). Set the actual size of the envelope from your  
software application.  
output bin. A print material exit area. The default is the  
standard output bin, located on top of the printer. A rear  
output bin, located on the back of the printer, is also  
available.  
overlay. Background text or graphics that appear  
consistent in each file that uses the overlay.  
P
pages per minute (ppm). The number of typical pages of  
text that can be printed in one minute.  
paper. See print material.  
paper guides. The length guide and the width guide  
located in an input tray that define proper placement of  
print material. Failing to properly adjust these guides may  
result in paper jams.  
Glossary  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
paper type. A printer setting that defines the type of print  
material (plain paper, card stock, transparency, label,  
bond, letterhead, preprinted, colored paper, envelope, or  
custom) loaded in a specified input source.  
parallel interface. A bidirectional interface for exchanging  
data between the computer and the printer.  
parallel/USB interface option card. An optional card that  
connects your printer to a parallel interface and a  
Universal Serial Bus (USB).  
pel. Picture element. The smallest addressable unit that  
can be effectively reproduced by the printer.  
photoconductor. An element of the print unit that works  
like film in a camera. As the photoconductor drum rotates,  
it uses positive and negative charges to alternately attract  
the toner necessary to define the image produced by the  
laser and transfer the image to the page. Fingerprints or  
scratches on the photoconductor prevent proper toner  
transfer and may result in reduced print quality.  
pitch. A unit of measure that determines the number of  
characters that can be printed in 1 horizontal inch. For  
example, a 10-pitch font prints 10 characters per inch (cpi).  
point. A unit of measure that determines the height of a  
printed character (1 point = 1/ 72 in.).  
point size. The height of the characters in a font.  
portrait orientation. Printed page orientation in which the  
height of the page is greater than the width.  
power saver. A printer setting that reduces power usage  
when the printer is idle. When the Power Saver message  
displays, the printer is ready to receive print jobs.  
ppm. See pages per minute.  
PQET. See Print Quality Enhancement Technology.  
Glossary  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
precharger wire. A wire inside the print unit that  
electrically charges the photoconductor during the  
printing process.  
Print and Hold job. A print job sent from your software  
application, stored in printer memory, and accessed at a  
later time from the CONFIDENTIAL JOB menu item or the  
HELD JOBS menu item. A Print and Hold job lets you  
delay the printing of a job, print it later, ask for additional  
copies, verify one copy before printing more, and access  
confidential print jobs by using a Personal Identification  
Number (PIN).  
print cartridge. The replaceable unit inside the printer  
that contains the photoconductor and toner supply.  
print material. Any material you print on, such as paper,  
card stock, envelopes, labels, and transparencies.  
Print Quality Enhancement Technology (PQET).  
A printer feature that improves the quality of text by  
smoothing the edges of characters and lines.  
print server. A device that lets you connect the printer to a  
local area network (LAN).  
printer driver. A program that translates software  
application language to printer language so data can be  
transferred.  
printer language. A set of defined commands (such as  
PCL or PostScript) to which the printer responds.  
printer memory. See dynamic random access memory  
(DRAM) or random access memory (RAM).  
proportionally spaced font. A font that varies the width  
of the character to allow uniform spacing around  
characters.  
protocol. A set of rules governing the communication and  
data transfer between two or more devices.  
Glossary  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
R
RAM. See random access memory.  
random access memory (RAM). Memory that allows  
rapid storage and retrieval of data. RAM contents are  
erased when electrical power is turned off.  
Ready. A printer state in which the printer can receive,  
process, and print data.  
resolution. A measure of the sharpness of a printed  
image, expressed in the number of dots per inch (dpi).  
S
scalable font. A font whose characters are stored only as  
outlines so it is easy to change (or scale) the size of the  
characters (measured in points).  
screen font. A downloadable font that appears the same  
on the computer screen as it does on a printed page.  
serial interface. A way of communicating between  
computer and printer by transmitting data one bit at a  
time.  
server. A device that allows the sharing of resources, such  
as printers, on a network.  
service message. An operator panel display message that  
indicates the printer needs service.  
setting. Values you choose from printer menus or  
software applications that control printer operation and  
the appearance of the printed page.  
setup utility. A program provided with the printer that  
installs printer drivers, tests printer setup, and completes  
the setup of printer options.  
short-edge binding. A printer setting that arranges the  
orientation and layout of a duplexed page to be bound  
along the short side of the page.  
simplex. See single-sided printing.  
Glossary  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
single-sided printing. Printing on only one side of a sheet  
of print material (simplex printing).  
SmartSwitch. A printer function that automatically  
switches the printer language to match that of the current  
print job.  
software application. Any program loaded on your  
computer used to perform a specific task, such as word  
processing or data compiling.  
Standard protocol. A parallel printer protocol where the  
printer receives information sent from the computer at a  
normal transmission rate.  
status message. A operator panel display message that  
provides information on the state of the printer.  
symbol set. A unique set of alphanumeric characters and  
symbols that the printer uses to print the requested font.  
Different symbol sets offer the diverse characters required  
for different languages or symbol-intense applications.  
system board. The printer main circuit board.  
T
timeout. A time interval allotted for certain operations.  
Token-Ring. A type of network communication that  
conforms to IEEE 802.5 standard. The name is derived  
from its physical ring configuration and the passing of a  
token from print server to print server.  
toner. The material that adheres to the print material to  
create a printed page.  
toner cartridge. See print cartridge.  
tray linking. A means of increasing input source capacity  
by feeding print material from one input source until it is  
empty and then automatically feeding print material from  
another input source.  
Glossary  
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tri-Port interface option card. An optional card you can  
install inside the printer to add support for LocalTalk,  
serial, and infrared interfaces.  
TrueType fonts. Fonts that use a single font outline for  
both screen display and printing. You can use TrueType  
fonts in Windows applications and scale them to any  
height. They print exactly as they appear on the screen.  
type size. A measurement in pitch or points of a graphic  
character in a font.  
type style. The form or shape of the characters in a font.  
typeface. The style that defines a group of characters and  
symbols.  
typographic fonts. Fonts whose characters are spaced  
proportionally on the page according to character width.  
U
Universal. Value to select for all print material excluding  
envelopes loaded in the multipurpose feeder that is not a  
standard size; defaults to 215.9 x 356 mm (8.5 x 14 in.). Set  
the actual size of the page from your software application.  
Universal Serial Bus (USB). An industry accepted serial  
bus for external devices. It replaces all the different types  
of serial and parallel ports with one standardized plug.  
USB. See Universal Serial Bus.  
user default. Printer setting selected by a user that  
remains in effect until a new user default is chosen.  
V
value. One of the settings available for a menu item.  
Glossary  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
W
watermark. See overlay.  
weight. The thickness of the typeface line or the thickness  
of print material.  
Glossary  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
attendance messages (continued)  
Numerics  
250-sheet input tray  
500-sheet drawer  
500-sheet input tray  
A
Index  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
attendance messages (continued)  
CD  
changing printer settings  
characters  
closing  
confidential jobs  
B
Config Menu  
configuring  
C
cable  
USB, attaching  
Card Stock & Label Guide x, 116, 118, 120  
Index  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
factory default settings (continued)  
Factory Defaults  
D
fax  
default settings  
dimensions  
disabling  
disk  
See hard disk option  
display problems  
Fax Menu  
Finishing Menu  
E
flash memory option  
envelopes  
F
factory default settings  
Index  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
flash memory option (continued)  
H
fonts  
hard disk option  
I
indicators  
G
guidelines  
information, online documents  
Card Stock & Label Guide x  
Technical Reference x  
infrared  
Infrared Menu  
Index  
288  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Infrared Menu (continued)  
Job Buffering  
job buffering  
input tray  
See tray  
installing  
Job Menu  
job statistics  
internal network adapter  
See internal print server  
L
LCD  
See liquid crystal display  
length guide, adjusting  
letterhead  
J
jagged  
jams, paper  
See paper jams  
Index  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
loading  
media guidelines (continued)  
memory  
menus  
LocalTalk Menu  
M
Macintosh  
selecting  
settings  
MarkVision  
media guidelines  
messages  
Index  
290  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
messages (continued)  
NPA Mode  
multipurpose feeder  
loading  
O
opening  
operator panel  
N
network adapter  
menu settings  
See internal print server  
messages  
Network Menu  
problems  
network printing problems  
Index  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
option card  
option problems  
paper (continued)  
options  
paper guide  
paper jams  
ordering supplies  
OS/ 2 Warp  
Paper Menu  
output bin  
P
paper  
paper size indicators  
jams  
selecting  
Index  
292  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
paper sources (continued)  
PCL emulation  
parallel cable  
PCL SmartSwitch  
Parallel Menu  
PIN  
See personal identification number  
PostScript 3 emulation  
parallel/ USB interface option card  
PostScript Menu  
part number  
print  
PCL Emul Menu  
HELD JOBS (Job Menu)  
Index  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
print cartridge  
print quality problems  
jagged  
print material  
guidelines  
printer  
attendance messages  
See attendance messages  
selecting  
sizes supported  
service messages  
See service messages  
Index  
294  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
printer (continued)  
status messages  
printing (continued)  
See status messages  
warning messages  
See warning messages  
printer messages  
attendance  
See attendance messages  
service  
printing problems  
See service messages  
status  
See problem solving  
problem solving  
See status messages  
warning messages  
See warning messages  
printer settings  
printer setup  
display  
printer states  
lost data  
printing  
network printing problems  
contents  
Index  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
problem solving (continued)  
operator panel  
problem solving (continued)  
printing problems (continued)  
options  
paper jams  
PS SmartSwitch  
print quality  
jagged  
Q
Quality Menu  
printer  
R
printing problems  
Index  
296  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
removing  
Serial Menu  
resetting  
settings  
resolution  
Setup Menu  
S
side cover  
scalable fonts  
selecting  
Index  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
sources of information, online documents  
Card Stock & Label Guide x  
Technical Reference x  
storing  
statistics  
See job statistics  
supplies  
print cartridge  
support unit  
system board  
T
Technical Reference x  
timeouts  
toner  
toner cartridge  
See print cartridge  
transparencies  
status, printer  
Index  
298  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
tray  
Utilities Menu  
V
U
unpacking  
USB cable  
W
attaching  
USB Menu  
user default settings  
width guide, adjusting  
Windows  
utilities  
Index  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
300  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Land Pride Lawn Mower 701 069A User Manual
Lennox International Inc Gas Heater Lennox Merit Series Gas Furnace Upflow Horizontal Air Discharge User Manual
Life Fitness Elliptical Trainer X30 User Manual
Life Fitness Fitness Equipment M051 00K59 0014 User Manual
Marantz CD Player CDR300 User Manual
Marvel Group Computer Hardware 88F6281 User Manual
M Audio Microphone 81602 User Manual
Maytag Washer W10373814A User Manual
Melissa Fondue Maker 643 052 User Manual
Metra Electronics Radio 95 7321 User Manual